Merge from gnus--devo--0
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / gnus.texi
CommitLineData
4009494e
GM
1\input texinfo
2
db78a8cb 3@setfilename ../../info/gnus
4009494e
GM
4@settitle Gnus Manual
5@syncodeindex fn cp
6@syncodeindex vr cp
7@syncodeindex pg cp
8
01c52d31
MB
9@documentencoding ISO-8859-1
10
4009494e
GM
11@copying
12Copyright @copyright{} 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
132002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14
15@quotation
16Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
17under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
18any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
19Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
20Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
21license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
22License'' in the Emacs manual.
23
24(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
25this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
26Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
27
28This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
29Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
30separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
31license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
32@end quotation
33@end copying
34
35@iftex
36@iflatex
37\documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
38\usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
39\usepackage{pagestyle}
40\usepackage{epsfig}
41\usepackage{pixidx}
42\input{gnusconfig.tex}
43
44\ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
45\else
46\usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
47\usepackage{thumbpdf}
48\pdfcompresslevel=9
49\fi
50
51\makeindex
52\begin{document}
53
54% Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
c7ff939a 55\newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.13}
4009494e
GM
56\newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
57\newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
58
59\newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
60
61\newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
62\ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
63\newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
64\else
65\newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
66\fi
67\newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
68\newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
69
70\newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
71\newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
72
73\newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
74\newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75\newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76\newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
77\newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
78\newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
79\newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
80\newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
81\newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
82\newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
83\newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
84\newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
85\newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
86\newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
87\newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
88\newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
89\newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
90\newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
91\newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
92\newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
93\newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
94\newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
95\newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
96\newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
97
98\newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
99\newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
100\newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
101\newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
102\newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
103\newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
104\newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
105\newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
106\newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
107\newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
108\newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
109\newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
110\newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
111
112\newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
113\newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
114\marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
115}
116
117\newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
118
119\newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
120{\mbox{}}
121}
122
123\newdimen{\gnusdimen}
124\gnusdimen 0pt
125
126\newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
127\gnuscleardoublepage
128\ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
129\chapter{#2}
130\renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
131\renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
132\thispagestyle{empty}
133\hspace*{-2cm}
134\begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
135\put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
136\put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
137\end{picture}
138\clearpage
139}
140
141\newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
142\begin{figure}
143\mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
144#3
145\end{picture}
146\caption{#1}
147\end{figure}
148}
149
150\newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
151\marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
152}
153
154\newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
155\margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
156}
157
158\newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
159\margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
160}
161
162\newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
163\margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
164}
165
166\newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
167
168\newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
169\renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
170\section{#1}
171}
172
173\newenvironment{codelist}%
174{\begin{list}{}{
175}
176}{\end{list}}
177
178\newenvironment{asislist}%
179{\begin{list}{}{
180}
181}{\end{list}}
182
183\newenvironment{kbdlist}%
184{\begin{list}{}{
185\labelwidth=0cm
186}
187}{\end{list}}
188
189\newenvironment{dfnlist}%
190{\begin{list}{}{
191}
192}{\end{list}}
193
194\newenvironment{stronglist}%
195{\begin{list}{}{
196}
197}{\end{list}}
198
199\newenvironment{samplist}%
200{\begin{list}{}{
201}
202}{\end{list}}
203
204\newenvironment{varlist}%
205{\begin{list}{}{
206}
207}{\end{list}}
208
209\newenvironment{emphlist}%
210{\begin{list}{}{
211}
212}{\end{list}}
213
214\newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
215\setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
216\addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
217
218\newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
219{
220{
221\ifodd\count0
222{
223\hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
224}
225\else
226{
227\hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
228}
229}
230\fi
231}
232}
233{
234\ifodd\count0
235\mbox{} \hfill
236\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
237\else
238\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
239\hfill \mbox{}
240\fi
241}
242
243\newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
244{
245{
246\ifodd\count0
247{
248\hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
249}
250\else
251{
252\hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
253}
254\fi
255}
256}
257{
258\ifodd\count0
259\mbox{} \hfill
260\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
261\else
262\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
263\hfill \mbox{}
264\fi
265}
266
267\newpagestyle{gnus}%
268{
269{
270\ifodd\count0
271{
272\makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
273}
274\else
275{
276\makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
277}
278\fi
279}
280}
281{
282\ifodd\count0
283\mbox{} \hfill
284\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
285\else
286\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
287\hfill \mbox{}
288\fi
289}
290
291\pagenumbering{roman}
292\pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
293
294@end iflatex
295@end iftex
296
297@iftex
298@iflatex
299
300\begin{titlepage}
301{
302
303%\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
304%\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
305\parindent=0cm
306\addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
307
308\gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
309\rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
310\vfill
311\hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
312\vfill
313\rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
314\gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
315\newpage
316}
317
318\mbox{}
319\vfill
320
321\thispagestyle{empty}
322
323@c @insertcopying
324\newpage
325\end{titlepage}
326@end iflatex
327@end iftex
328
329@ifnottex
330@insertcopying
331@end ifnottex
332
333@dircategory Emacs
334@direntry
335* Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
336@end direntry
337@iftex
338@finalout
339@end iftex
340@setchapternewpage odd
341
342
343
344@titlepage
345@title Gnus Manual
346
347@author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
348@page
349@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
350@insertcopying
351@end titlepage
352
353
354@node Top
355@top The Gnus Newsreader
356
357@ifinfo
358
359You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
360can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
361spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
362luck.
363
364@c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
c7ff939a 365This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
4009494e
GM
366
367@end ifinfo
368
369@iftex
370
371@iflatex
372\tableofcontents
373\gnuscleardoublepage
374@end iflatex
375
376Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
377unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
378
379Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
380being accused of plagiarism:
381
382Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
383about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
384you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
385can even read news with it!
386
387Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
388people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
389allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
390like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
391people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
392the program.
393
394@end iftex
395
396@menu
397* Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
398* Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
399* Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
400* Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
401* Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
402* Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
403* Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
404* Various:: General purpose settings.
405* The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
406* Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
407* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
408* Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
409* Key Index:: Key Index.
410
411Other related manuals
412
413* Message:(message). Composing messages.
414* Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
415* Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
416* PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
01c52d31 417* SASL:(sasl). @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
4009494e
GM
418
419@detailmenu
420 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
421
422Starting Gnus
423
424* Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
425* The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
426* The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
427* Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
428* Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
429* New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
430* Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
431* Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
432* Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
433* The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
434* Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
435
436New Groups
437
438* Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
439* Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
440* Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
441
442Group Buffer
443
444* Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
445* Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
446* Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
447* Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
448* Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
449* Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
450* Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
451* Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
452* Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
453* Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
454* Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
455* Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
456* Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
457* Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
458* Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
459* Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
01c52d31 460* Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
4009494e
GM
461* Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
462
463Group Buffer Format
464
465* Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
466* Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
467* Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
468
469Group Topics
470
471* Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
472* Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
473* Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
474* Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
475* Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
476
477Misc Group Stuff
478
479* Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
480* Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
481* Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
482* File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
483* Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
484
485Summary Buffer
486
487* Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
488* Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
489* Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
490* Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
491* Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
492* Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
493* Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
494* Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
495* Threading:: How threads are made.
496* Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
497* Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
498* Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
499* Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
01c52d31 500* Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4009494e
GM
501* Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
502* Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
503* Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
504* Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
505* MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
506* Charsets:: Character set issues.
507* Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
508* Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
509* Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
510* Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
511* Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
512* Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
513* Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
514* Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
515 or reselecting the current group.
516* Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
517* Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
518* Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
519* Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
520
521Summary Buffer Format
522
523* Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
524* To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
525* Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
526* Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
527
528Choosing Articles
529
530* Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
531* Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
532
533Reply, Followup and Post
534
535* Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
536* Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
537* Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
538* Canceling and Superseding::
539
540Marking Articles
541
542* Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
543* Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
544* Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
545* Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
546* Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
547* Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
548
549Threading
550
551* Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
552* Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
553
554Customizing Threading
555
556* Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
557* Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
558* More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
559* Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
560
561Decoding Articles
562
563* Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
564* Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
565* PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
566* Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
567* Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
568* Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
569
570Decoding Variables
571
572* Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
573* Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
574* Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
575
576Article Treatment
577
578* Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
579* Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
580* Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
581* Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
582* Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
583* Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
584* Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
585* Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
586* Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
587* Article Signature:: What is a signature?
588* Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
589
590Alternative Approaches
591
592* Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
593* Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
594
595Various Summary Stuff
596
597* Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
598* Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
599* Summary Generation Commands::
600* Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
601
602Article Buffer
603
604* Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
605* Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
606* Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
607* Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
608* Misc Article:: Other stuff.
609
610Composing Messages
611
612* Mail:: Mailing and replying.
613* Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
614* POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
615* Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
616* Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
617* Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
618* Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
619* Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
620* Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
621
622Select Methods
623
624* Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
625* Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
626* Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
627* Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
628* IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
629* Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
630* Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
631* Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
632* Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
633
634Server Buffer
635
636* Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
637* Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
638* Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
639* Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
640* Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
641* Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
642* Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
643
644Getting News
645
646* NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
647* News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
648
649@acronym{NNTP}
650
651* Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
652* Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
653* Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
01c52d31 654* NNTP marks:: Storing marks for @acronym{NNTP} servers.
4009494e
GM
655
656Getting Mail
657
658* Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
659* Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
660* Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
661* Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
662* Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
663* Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
664* Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
665* Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
666* Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
667* Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
668* Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
669* Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
670* Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
671
672Mail Sources
673
674* Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
675* Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
676* Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
677
678Choosing a Mail Back End
679
680* Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
681* Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
682* Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
683* MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
684* Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
685* Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
686* Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
687
688Browsing the Web
689
690* Archiving Mail::
691* Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
692* Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
693* Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
694* Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
695* RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
696* Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
697
698@acronym{IMAP}
699
700* Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
701* Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
702* Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
703* Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
704* A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
705* Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
706
707Other Sources
708
709* Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
710* Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
711* Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
712* SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
713* Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
714
715Document Groups
716
717* Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
718
719SOUP
720
721* SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
722* SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
723* SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
724
725Combined Groups
726
727* Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
728* Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
729
730Email Based Diary
731
732* The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
733* The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
734* Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
735
736The NNDiary Back End
737
738* Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
739* Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
740* Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
741
742The Gnus Diary Library
743
744* Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
745* Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
746* Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
747* Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
748
749Gnus Unplugged
750
751* Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
752* Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
753* Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
754* Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
755* Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
756* Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
757* Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
01c52d31 758* Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
4009494e
GM
759* Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
760* Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
761* Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
762* Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
763* Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
764* Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
765
766Agent Categories
767
768* Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
769* Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
770* Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
771
772Agent Commands
773
774* Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
775* Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
776* Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
777
778Scoring
779
780* Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
781* Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
782* Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
783* Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
784* Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
785* Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
786* Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
787* Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
788* Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
789* Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
790* Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
791* Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
792* Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
793* Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
4009494e
GM
794* Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
795* Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
796
4009494e
GM
797Advanced Scoring
798
799* Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
800* Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
801* Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
802
803Various
804
805* Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
806* Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
807* Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
808* Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
809* Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
810* Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
811* Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
812* Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
813* Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
814* Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
815* Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
816* NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
817* Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
818* Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
819* Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
820* Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
821* Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
822* Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
823* Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
824* Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
825* Various Various:: Things that are really various.
826
827Formatting Variables
828
829* Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
830* Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
831* Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
832* User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
833* Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
834* Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
835* Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
836* Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
837
838Image Enhancements
839
840* X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
841* Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
842* Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
843 meant to be shown.
844* Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
845* XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
846
847Thwarting Email Spam
848
849* The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
850* Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
851* SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
852* Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
853
854Spam Package
855
856* Spam Package Introduction::
857* Filtering Incoming Mail::
858* Detecting Spam in Groups::
859* Spam and Ham Processors::
860* Spam Package Configuration Examples::
861* Spam Back Ends::
862* Extending the Spam package::
863* Spam Statistics Package::
864
865Spam Statistics Package
866
867* Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
868* Splitting mail using spam-stat::
869* Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
870
871Appendices
872
873* XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
874* History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
875* On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
876* Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
877* Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
878* Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
879* Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
880* Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
881* Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
882
883History
884
885* Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
886* Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
887* Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
888* Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
889* Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
890* Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
891* Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
892* Contributors:: Oodles of people.
893* New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
894
895New Features
896
897* ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
898* September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
899* Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
900* Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
901* Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
902* Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
01c52d31 903* No Gnus:: Very punny.
4009494e
GM
904
905Customization
906
907* Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
908* Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
909* Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
910* Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
911
912Gnus Reference Guide
913
914* Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
915* Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
916* Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
917* Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
918* Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
919* Group Info:: The group info format.
920* Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
921* Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
922* Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
923
924Back End Interface
925
926* Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
927* Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
928* Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
929* Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
930* Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
931* Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
932
933Various File Formats
934
935* Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
936* Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
937
938Emacs for Heathens
939
940* Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
941* Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
942
943@end detailmenu
944@end menu
945
946@node Starting Up
947@chapter Starting Gnus
948@cindex starting up
949
950If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
951Heathens} first.
952
953@kindex M-x gnus
954@findex gnus
955If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
956and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
957your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
958@code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
959minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
960@code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
961
962@findex gnus-other-frame
963@kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
964If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
965@kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
966
967If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
968variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
969@file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
970
971If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
972terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
973
974@menu
975* Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
976* The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
977* The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
978* Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
979* New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
980* Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
981* Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
982* Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
983* The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
984* Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
985@end menu
986
987
988@node Finding the News
989@section Finding the News
990@cindex finding news
991
992@vindex gnus-select-method
993@c @head
994The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
995news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
996@dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
997native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
998foreign groups.
999
1000For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1001you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1002
1003@lisp
1004(setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1005@end lisp
1006
1007If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1008
1009@lisp
1010(setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1011@end lisp
1012
1013If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1014certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1015server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1016server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1017
1018@vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1019@cindex NNTPSERVER
1020@cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1021If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1022@env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1023Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1024(@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1025If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1026as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1027
1028@vindex gnus-nntp-server
1029If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1030@code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1031@code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1032
1033@vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1034@vindex gnus-nntp-server
1035You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1036@acronym{NNTP} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1037(i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
1038in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1039type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1040will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1041gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1042server.)
1043
1044@findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1045@kindex B (Group)
1046However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1047interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1048better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1049let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1050to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1051maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1052
1053@vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1054@c @head
1055A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1056@code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1057listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1058@code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1059files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1060appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1061groups are.
1062
1063For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1064you would typically set this variable to
1065
1066@lisp
1067(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1068@end lisp
1069
01c52d31
MB
1070Note: the @acronym{NNTP} back end stores marks in marks files
1071(@pxref{NNTP marks}). This feature makes it easy to share marks between
1072several Gnus installations, but may slow down things a bit when fetching
1073new articles. @xref{NNTP marks}, for more information.
1074
4009494e
GM
1075
1076@node The First Time
1077@section The First Time
1078@cindex first time usage
1079
1080If no startup files exist (@pxref{Startup Files}), Gnus will try to
1081determine what groups should be subscribed by default.
1082
1083@vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1084If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
1085will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1086killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1087something useful.
1088
1089Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1090picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1091here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1092
1093You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1094help you with most common problems.
1095
1096If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1097use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1098special.
1099
1100
1101@node The Server is Down
1102@section The Server is Down
1103@cindex server errors
1104
1105If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1106problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1107the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1108
1109Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1110without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1111will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1112given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1113for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1114groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1115buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1116
1117@findex gnus-no-server
1118@kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1119@c @head
1120If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1121your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1122@code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1123if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1124your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
11251 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1126levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1127
1128
1129@node Slave Gnusae
1130@section Slave Gnusae
1131@cindex slave
1132
1133You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1134same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1135are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1136that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1137
1138The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1139@file{.newsrc} file.
1140
1141To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1142Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1143@dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1144taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1145conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1146me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1147Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1148
1149@findex gnus-slave
1150Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1151however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1152@kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1153files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1154on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1155starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1156information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1157they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1158
1159Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1160information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1161
1162If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1163slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1164file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1165incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1166messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1167
1168
1169
1170@node New Groups
1171@section New Groups
1172@cindex new groups
1173@cindex subscription
1174
1175@vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1176If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1177you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1178also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1179@code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1180@kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1181is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1182@code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1183when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1184
1185@menu
1186* Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1187* Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1188* Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1189@end menu
1190
1191
1192@node Checking New Groups
1193@subsection Checking New Groups
1194
1195Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1196list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1197dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1198@code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1199server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1200cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1201groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1202@code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1203Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1204Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1205
1206I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1207server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1208fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1209@code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1210few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1211work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1212supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1213You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1214whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1215it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1216@samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1217
1218This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1219issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1220subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1221if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1222that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1223Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1224
1225
1226@node Subscription Methods
1227@subsection Subscription Methods
1228
1229@vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1230What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1231@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1232
1233This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1234with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1235
1236Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1237
1238@table @code
1239
1240@item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1241@vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1242Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1243zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1244(with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1245
1246@item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1247@vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1248Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1249new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1250
1251@item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1252@vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1253Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1254
1255@item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1256@vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1257Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1258function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1259@code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1260alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1261hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1262@samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1263up. Or something like that.
1264
1265@item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1266@vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1267Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1268you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1269to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1270
1271@item gnus-subscribe-killed
1272@vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1273Kill all new groups.
1274
1275@item gnus-subscribe-topics
1276@vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1277Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1278parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1279topic parameter that looks like
1280
1281@example
1282"nnslashdot"
1283@end example
1284
1285will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1286that topic.
1287
1288If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1289top-level topic.
1290
1291@end table
1292
1293@vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1294A closely related variable is
1295@code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1296mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1297hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1298will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1299hierarchy or not.
1300
1301One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1302(@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1303@code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1304will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1305
1306
1307@node Filtering New Groups
1308@subsection Filtering New Groups
1309
1310A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1311subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1312the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1313
1314@example
1315options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1316@end example
1317
1318@vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1319This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1320person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1321groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1322be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1323be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1324subscribing these groups.
1325@code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1326variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1327
1328@vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1329@vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1330If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1331set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1332@code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1333same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1334and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1335subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1336
1337@vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1338Yet another variable that meddles here is
1339@code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1340@code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1341but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1342more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1343used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1344groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1345@code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1346subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1347@code{nil}.
1348
1349New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1350@code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1351
1352
1353@node Changing Servers
1354@section Changing Servers
1355@cindex changing servers
1356
1357Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1358This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1359very flaky and you want to use another.
1360
1361Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1362@code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1363
1364@emph{Wrong!}
1365
1366Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1367@acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1368you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1369change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1370worthless.
1371
1372Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1373file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1374common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1375functions more than absolutely necessary.
1376
1377@kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1378@findex gnus-change-server
1379If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1380the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1381article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1382gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1383will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1384
1385@kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1386@findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1387You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1388gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1389move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1390
1391@kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1392@findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1393If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1394and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1395gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1396that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1397
1398@kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1399@findex gnus-group-clear-data
1400Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1401list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1402
1403After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1404since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1405affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1406@code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1407to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1408can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1409cache for all groups).
1410
1411
1412@node Startup Files
1413@section Startup Files
1414@cindex startup files
1415@cindex .newsrc
1416@cindex .newsrc.el
1417@cindex .newsrc.eld
1418
1419Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1420@file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1421groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1422read.
1423
1424Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1425keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1426@file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1427the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1428the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1429files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1430@sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1431
1432That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1433@file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1434@file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1435recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1436never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1437not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1438
1439@vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1440@vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1441You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1442@code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1443the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1444However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1445Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1446@code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1447@file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1448convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1449want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1450news reader.
1451
1452@vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1453If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1454will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1455save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1456will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1457so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1458You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1459@code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1460Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1461the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1462saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1463several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1464
1465@vindex gnus-startup-file
1466@vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1467@vindex version-control
1468The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1469The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1470file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1471If you want version control for this file, set
1472@code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1473@code{version-control} variable.
1474
1475@vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1476@vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1477@vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1478@code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1479files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1480saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1481@code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1482@file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1483control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1484startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1485
1486@lisp
1487(defun turn-off-backup ()
1488 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1489
1490(add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1491(add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1492@end lisp
1493
1494@vindex gnus-init-file
1495@vindex gnus-site-init-file
1496When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1497(@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1498(@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1499and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1500@file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1501with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1502suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1503@file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1504and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1505the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1506Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1507@code{gnus-init-file}.
1508
1509
1510@node Auto Save
1511@section Auto Save
1512@cindex dribble file
1513@cindex auto-save
1514
1515Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1516catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1517special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1518Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1519@file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1520this file.
1521
1522If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1523read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1524saved.
1525
1526@vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1527If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1528maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1529
1530@vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1531Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1532this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1533into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1534normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1535file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1536
1537@vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1538If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1539read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1540
1541
1542@node The Active File
1543@section The Active File
1544@cindex active file
1545@cindex ignored groups
1546
1547When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1548articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1549file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1550
1551@vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1552Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1553regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1554any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1555ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1556recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1557Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1558
1559@c This variable is
1560@c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1561@c if you set it to anything else.
1562
1563@vindex gnus-read-active-file
1564@c @head
1565The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1566can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1567reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1568
1569Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1570you actually subscribe to.
1571
1572Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1573variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1574present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1575considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1576
1577This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1578attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1579servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1580support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1581at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1582is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1583
1584Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1585instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1586servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1587variable.
1588
1589If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1590lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1591@acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1592read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1593performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1594@code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1595
1596If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1597different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1598
1599In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1600kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1601
1602Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1603secondary select methods.
1604
1605
1606@node Startup Variables
1607@section Startup Variables
1608
1609@table @code
1610
1611@item gnus-load-hook
1612@vindex gnus-load-hook
1613A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1614normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1615times you start Gnus.
1616
1617@item gnus-before-startup-hook
1618@vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1619A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1620
1621@item gnus-startup-hook
1622@vindex gnus-startup-hook
1623A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1624
1625@item gnus-started-hook
1626@vindex gnus-started-hook
1627A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1628successfully.
1629
1630@item gnus-setup-news-hook
1631@vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1632A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1633generating the group buffer.
1634
1635@item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1636@vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1637If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1638startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1639@file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1640bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1641best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1642in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1643
1644@item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1645@vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1646If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1647your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1648of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1649@file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1650
1651@item gnus-no-groups-message
1652@vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1653Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1654
1655@item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1656@vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1657If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1658
1659@item gnus-startup-jingle
1660@vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1661Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1662default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1663
1664@end table
1665
1666
1667@node Group Buffer
1668@chapter Group Buffer
1669@cindex group buffer
1670
1671@c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1672@c
1673@c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1674@c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1675@c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1676@c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1677@c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1678@c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1679@c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1680@c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1681@c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1682@c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1683@c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1684@c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1685@c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1686@c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1687@c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1688@c human rights at 9...
1689
1690
1691The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1692is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1693long as Gnus is active.
1694
1695@iftex
1696@iflatex
1697\gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1698\put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1699\put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1700\put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1701\put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1702\put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1703\put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1704\put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1705}
1706@end iflatex
1707@end iftex
1708
1709@menu
1710* Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1711* Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1712* Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1713* Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1714* Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1715* Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1716* Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1717* Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1718* Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1719* Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1720* Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1721* Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1722* Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1723* Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1724* Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1725* Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
01c52d31 1726* Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
4009494e
GM
1727* Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1728@end menu
1729
1730
1731@node Group Buffer Format
1732@section Group Buffer Format
1733
1734@menu
1735* Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1736* Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1737* Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1738@end menu
1739
1740You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1741customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1742available in Emacs.
1743
1744The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1745cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1746slower. You can disable this via the variable
1747@code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1748Emacs version.
1749
1750@node Group Line Specification
1751@subsection Group Line Specification
1752@cindex group buffer format
1753
1754The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1755make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1756
1757Here's a couple of example group lines:
1758
1759@example
1760 25: news.announce.newusers
1761 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1762@end example
1763
1764Quite simple, huh?
1765
1766You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1767@samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1768ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1769asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1770
1771@vindex gnus-group-line-format
1772You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1773@code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1774lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1775a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1776@xref{Formatting Variables}.
1777
1778@samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1779
1780There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1781the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1782Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1783displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1784Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1785
1786(Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1787layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1788instead of wasting time reading news.)
1789
1790Here's a list of all available format characters:
1791
1792@table @samp
1793
1794@item M
1795An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1796
1797@item S
1798Whether the group is subscribed.
1799
1800@item L
1801Level of subscribedness.
1802
1803@item N
1804Number of unread articles.
1805
1806@item I
1807Number of dormant articles.
1808
1809@item T
1810Number of ticked articles.
1811
1812@item R
1813Number of read articles.
1814
1815@item U
1816Number of unseen articles.
1817
1818@item t
1819Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1820minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1821
1822Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1823efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1824the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1825hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1826unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1827interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
01c52d31
MB
1828end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job.
1829
1830The nnml backend (@pxref{Mail Spool}) has a feature called ``group
1831compaction'' which circumvents this deficiency: the idea is to
1832renumber all articles from 1, removing all gaps between numbers, hence
1833getting a correct total count. Other backends may support this in the
1834future. In order to keep your total article count relatively up to
1835date, you might want to compact your groups (or even directly your
1836server) from time to time. @xref{Misc Group Stuff}, @xref{Server Commands}.
4009494e
GM
1837
1838@item y
1839Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1840
1841@item i
1842Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1843
1844@item g
1845Full group name.
1846
1847@item G
1848Group name.
1849
1850@item C
1851Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1852comment element in the group parameters.
1853
1854@item D
1855Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1856before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1857@code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1858command.
1859
1860@item o
1861@samp{m} if moderated.
1862
1863@item O
1864@samp{(m)} if moderated.
1865
1866@item s
1867Select method.
1868
1869@item B
1870If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1871
1872@item n
1873Select from where.
1874
1875@item z
1876A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1877used.
1878
1879@item P
1880Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1881
1882@item c
1883@vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1884Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1885variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1886The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1887@samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1888
1889@item m
1890@vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1891@cindex %
1892@samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1893the group lately.
1894
1895@item p
1896@samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1897
1898@item d
1899A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1900Timestamp}).
1901
01c52d31
MB
1902@item F
1903The disk space used by the articles fetched by both the cache and
1904agent. The value is automatically scaled to bytes(B), kilobytes(K),
1905megabytes(M), or gigabytes(G) to minimize the column width. A format
1906of %7F is sufficient for a fixed-width column.
1907
4009494e
GM
1908@item u
1909User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1910be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1911@code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1912following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1913parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1914be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1915specifier.
1916@end table
1917
1918@cindex *
1919All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1920if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1921group, or a bogus native group.
1922
1923
1924@node Group Mode Line Specification
1925@subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1926@cindex group mode line
1927
1928@vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1929The mode line can be changed by setting
1930@code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1931doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1932
1933@table @samp
1934@item S
1935The native news server.
1936@item M
1937The native select method.
1938@end table
1939
1940
1941@node Group Highlighting
1942@subsection Group Highlighting
1943@cindex highlighting
1944@cindex group highlighting
1945
1946@vindex gnus-group-highlight
1947Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1948@code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1949that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1950something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1951
1952Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1953background is dark:
1954
1955@lisp
1956(cond (window-system
1957 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1958 (defface my-group-face-1
1959 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1960 (defface my-group-face-2
1961 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1962 "Second group face")
1963 (defface my-group-face-3
1964 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1965 (defface my-group-face-4
1966 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1967 (defface my-group-face-5
1968 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1969
1970(setq gnus-group-highlight
1971 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1972 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1973 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1974 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1975 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1976@end lisp
1977
1978Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1979
1980Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1981include:
1982
1983@table @code
1984@item group
1985The group name.
1986@item unread
1987The number of unread articles in the group.
1988@item method
1989The select method.
1990@item mailp
1991Whether the group is a mail group.
1992@item level
1993The level of the group.
1994@item score
1995The score of the group.
1996@item ticked
1997The number of ticked articles in the group.
1998@item total
1999The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
2000@var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
2001@item topic
2002When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
2003topic being inserted.
2004@end table
2005
2006When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
2007of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
2008functions for snarfing info on the group.
2009
2010@vindex gnus-group-update-hook
2011@findex gnus-group-highlight-line
2012@code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
2013It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
2014calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
2015
2016
2017@node Group Maneuvering
2018@section Group Maneuvering
2019@cindex group movement
2020
2021All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
2022expected, hopefully.
2023
2024@table @kbd
2025
2026@item n
2027@kindex n (Group)
2028@findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
2029Go to the next group that has unread articles
2030(@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
2031
2032@item p
2033@itemx DEL
2034@kindex DEL (Group)
2035@kindex p (Group)
2036@findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
2037Go to the previous group that has unread articles
2038(@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
2039
2040@item N
2041@kindex N (Group)
2042@findex gnus-group-next-group
2043Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2044
2045@item P
2046@kindex P (Group)
2047@findex gnus-group-prev-group
2048Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2049
2050@item M-n
2051@kindex M-n (Group)
2052@findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2053Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2054(@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2055
2056@item M-p
2057@kindex M-p (Group)
2058@findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2059Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2060(@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2061@end table
2062
2063Three commands for jumping to groups:
2064
2065@table @kbd
2066
2067@item j
2068@kindex j (Group)
2069@findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2070Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2071(@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2072like living groups.
2073
2074@item ,
2075@kindex , (Group)
2076@findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2077Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2078(@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2079
2080@item .
2081@kindex . (Group)
2082@findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2083Jump to the first group with unread articles
2084(@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2085@end table
2086
2087@vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2088If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2089commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2090the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2091is @code{t}.
2092
01c52d31
MB
2093@vindex gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit
2094If @code{gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit} is @code{t}, when a summary is
2095exited, the point in the group buffer is moved to the next unread group.
2096Otherwise, the point is set to the group just exited. The default is
2097@code{t}.
4009494e
GM
2098
2099@node Selecting a Group
2100@section Selecting a Group
2101@cindex group selection
2102
2103@table @kbd
2104
2105@item SPACE
2106@kindex SPACE (Group)
2107@findex gnus-group-read-group
2108Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2109first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2110unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2111this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2112group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2113determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2114positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2115negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2116
2117Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2118articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2119- 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2120
2121When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2122@kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2123ones.
2124
2125@item RET
2126@kindex RET (Group)
2127@findex gnus-group-select-group
2128Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2129(@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2130@code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2131does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2132entry.
2133
2134@item M-RET
2135@kindex M-RET (Group)
2136@findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2137This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2138minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2139scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2140expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2141enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2142(i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2143which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2144summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2145
2146@item M-SPACE
2147@kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2148@findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2149This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2150command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2151(@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2152
2153@item C-M-RET
2154@kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2155@findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2156Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2157doing any processing of its contents
2158(@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2159turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2160manner will have no permanent effects.
2161
2162@end table
2163
2164@vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2165The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2166consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2167considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2168(unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2169before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2170articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2171negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2172fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2173most recently will be fetched.
2174
2175@vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2176@code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2177@code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2178newsgroups.
2179
4b70e299 2180@vindex gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles
4009494e
GM
2181In groups in some news servers, there might be a big gap between a few
2182very old articles that will never be expired and the recent ones. In
2183such a case, the server will return the data like @code{(1 . 30000000)}
2184for the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, for example. Even if there
2185are actually only the articles 1-10 and 29999900-30000000, Gnus doesn't
2186know it at first and prepares for getting 30000000 articles. However,
2187it will consume hundreds megabytes of memories and might make Emacs get
2188stuck as the case may be. If you use such news servers, set the
4b70e299
MB
2189variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} to a positive number.
2190The value means that Gnus ignores articles other than this number of the
2191latest ones in every group. For instance, the value 10000 makes Gnus
2192get only the articles 29990001-30000000 (if the latest article number is
219330000000 in a group). Note that setting this variable to a number might
2194prevent you from reading very old articles. The default value of the
2195variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} is @code{nil}, which
2196means Gnus never ignores old articles.
4009494e
GM
2197
2198@vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2199@vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2200@vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2201If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2202automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2203Which article this is is controlled by the
2204@code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2205variable are:
2206
2207@table @code
2208
2209@item unread
2210Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2211
2212@item first
2213Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2214
2215@item unseen
2216Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2217
2218@item unseen-or-unread
2219Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2220there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2221unread article.
2222
2223@item best
2224Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2225
2226@end table
2227
2228This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2229will be called to place point on a subject line.
2230
2231If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2232binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2233@code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2234@code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2235selected.
2236
2237
2238@node Subscription Commands
2239@section Subscription Commands
2240@cindex subscription
2241
2242@table @kbd
2243
2244@item S t
2245@itemx u
2246@kindex S t (Group)
2247@kindex u (Group)
2248@findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2249@c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2250Toggle subscription to the current group
2251(@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2252
2253@item S s
2254@itemx U
2255@kindex S s (Group)
2256@kindex U (Group)
2257@findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2258Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2259subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2260(@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2261
2262@item S k
2263@itemx C-k
2264@kindex S k (Group)
2265@kindex C-k (Group)
2266@findex gnus-group-kill-group
2267@c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2268Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2269
2270@item S y
2271@itemx C-y
2272@kindex S y (Group)
2273@kindex C-y (Group)
2274@findex gnus-group-yank-group
2275Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2276
2277@item C-x C-t
2278@kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2279@findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2280Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2281really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2282kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2283
2284@item S w
2285@itemx C-w
2286@kindex S w (Group)
2287@kindex C-w (Group)
2288@findex gnus-group-kill-region
2289Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2290
2291@item S z
2292@kindex S z (Group)
2293@findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2294Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2295
2296@item S C-k
2297@kindex S C-k (Group)
2298@findex gnus-group-kill-level
2299Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2300These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2301be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2302really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2303groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2304kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2305@file{.newsrc} file.
2306
2307@end table
2308
2309Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2310
2311
2312@node Group Data
2313@section Group Data
2314
2315@table @kbd
2316
2317@item c
2318@kindex c (Group)
2319@findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2320@vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2321@c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2322Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2323(@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2324@code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2325the group buffer.
2326
2327@item C
2328@kindex C (Group)
2329@findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2330Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2331(@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2332
2333@item M-c
2334@kindex M-c (Group)
2335@findex gnus-group-clear-data
2336Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2337read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2338
2339@item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2340@kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2341@findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2342If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2343and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2344clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2345caution.
2346
2347@end table
2348
2349
2350@node Group Levels
2351@section Group Levels
2352@cindex group level
2353@cindex level
2354
2355All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2356group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2357can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2358(@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2359a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2360
2361Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2362
2363@table @kbd
2364
2365@item S l
2366@kindex S l (Group)
2367@findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2368Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2369next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2370prompted for a level.
2371@end table
2372
2373@vindex gnus-level-killed
2374@vindex gnus-level-zombie
2375@vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2376@vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2377Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2378@code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2379@code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2380@code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2381unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2382(default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2383(default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2384same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2385you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2386groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2387reasons of efficiency.
2388
2389It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2390low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2391
2392Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2393understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2394subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2395empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2396go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2397groups are hidden, in a way.
2398
2399Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2400are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2401unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2402information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2403and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2404aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2405
2406Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2407a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2408group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2409but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2410the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2411list of killed groups.)
2412
2413If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2414Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2415them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2416
2417@vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2418@vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2419Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2420(default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2421which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2422(un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2423relevant valid ranges.
2424
2425@vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2426If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2427will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2428particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2429will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2430handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2431rest.
2432
2433If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2434one with the best level.
2435
2436@vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2437All groups with a level less than or equal to
2438@code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2439by default.
2440
2441@vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2442If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2443groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2444@code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2445listed.
2446
2447@vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2448If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2449give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2450use this level as the ``work'' level.
2451
2452@vindex gnus-activate-level
2453Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2454on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2455activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2456to 5. The default is 6.
2457
2458
2459@node Group Score
2460@section Group Score
2461@cindex group score
2462@cindex group rank
2463@cindex rank
2464
2465You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2466is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2467group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2468reason?
2469
2470This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2471to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2472the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2473score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2474called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2475a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2476of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2477least significant part.))
2478
2479@findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2480If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2481read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2482the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2483sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2484action after each summary exit, you can add
2485@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2486@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2487slow things down somewhat.
2488
2489
2490@node Marking Groups
2491@section Marking Groups
2492@cindex marking groups
2493
2494If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2495subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2496numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2497bidding on those groups.
2498
2499However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2500perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2501with the process mark and then execute the command.
2502
2503@table @kbd
2504
2505@item #
2506@kindex # (Group)
2507@itemx M m
2508@kindex M m (Group)
2509@findex gnus-group-mark-group
2510Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2511
2512@item M-#
2513@kindex M-# (Group)
2514@itemx M u
2515@kindex M u (Group)
2516@findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2517Remove the mark from the current group
2518(@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2519
2520@item M U
2521@kindex M U (Group)
2522@findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2523Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2524
2525@item M w
2526@kindex M w (Group)
2527@findex gnus-group-mark-region
2528Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2529
2530@item M b
2531@kindex M b (Group)
2532@findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2533Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2534
2535@item M r
2536@kindex M r (Group)
2537@findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2538Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2539(@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2540@end table
2541
2542Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2543
2544@findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2545If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2546with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2547(@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2548the command to be executed.
2549
2550
2551@node Foreign Groups
2552@section Foreign Groups
2553@cindex foreign groups
2554
2555Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2556groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2557special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2558groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2559consulted.
2560
2561Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2562@file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2563variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2564
2565@table @kbd
2566
2567@item G m
2568@kindex G m (Group)
2569@findex gnus-group-make-group
2570@cindex making groups
2571Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2572for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2573to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2574
2575@item G M
2576@kindex G M (Group)
2577@findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2578Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2579will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2580
2581@item G r
2582@kindex G r (Group)
2583@findex gnus-group-rename-group
2584@cindex renaming groups
2585Rename the current group to something else
2586(@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2587groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2588on some back ends.
2589
2590@item G c
2591@kindex G c (Group)
2592@cindex customizing
2593@findex gnus-group-customize
2594Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2595
2596@item G e
2597@kindex G e (Group)
2598@findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2599@cindex renaming groups
2600Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2601group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2602
2603@item G p
2604@kindex G p (Group)
2605@findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2606Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2607(@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2608
2609@item G E
2610@kindex G E (Group)
2611@findex gnus-group-edit-group
2612Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2613(@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2614
2615@item G d
2616@kindex G d (Group)
2617@findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2618@cindex nndir
2619Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2620for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2621
2622@item G h
2623@kindex G h (Group)
2624@cindex help group
2625@findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2626Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2627
2628@item G a
2629@kindex G a (Group)
2630@cindex (ding) archive
2631@cindex archive group
2632@findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2633@vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2634@vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2635Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2636default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2637(@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2638group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2639
2640@item G k
2641@kindex G k (Group)
2642@findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2643@cindex nnkiboze
2644Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2645match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2646strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2647@xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2648
2649@item G D
2650@kindex G D (Group)
2651@findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2652@cindex nneething
2653Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2654@code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2655@xref{Anything Groups}.
2656
2657@item G f
2658@kindex G f (Group)
2659@findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2660@cindex ClariNet Briefs
2661@cindex nndoc
2662Make a group based on some file or other
2663(@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2664command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2665Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2666@code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2667@code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2668@code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2669@code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2670you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2671type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2672
2673@item G u
2674@kindex G u (Group)
2675@vindex gnus-useful-groups
2676@findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2677Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2678(@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2679
2680@item G w
2681@kindex G w (Group)
2682@findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2683@cindex Google
2684@cindex nnweb
2685@cindex gmane
2686Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2687(@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2688command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2689search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2690include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2691@xref{Web Searches}.
2692
2693If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2694to a particular group by using a match string like
2695@samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2696
2697@item G R
2698@kindex G R (Group)
2699@findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2700Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2701(@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2702@xref{RSS}.
2703
2704@item G DEL
2705@kindex G DEL (Group)
2706@findex gnus-group-delete-group
2707This function will delete the current group
2708(@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2709actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2710group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2711absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2712read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2713
2714@item G V
2715@kindex G V (Group)
2716@findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2717Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2718(@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2719
2720@item G v
2721@kindex G v (Group)
2722@findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2723Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2724(@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2725@end table
2726
2727@xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2728methods.
2729
2730@vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2731If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2732Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2733This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2734groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2735@code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2736newsgroups.
2737
2738
2739@node Group Parameters
2740@section Group Parameters
2741@cindex group parameters
2742
2743The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2744Here's an example group parameter list:
2745
2746@example
2747((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2748 (auto-expire . t))
2749@end example
2750
2751We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2752the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2753parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2754not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2755
2756Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2757is an alist of regexps and values.
2758
2759The following group parameters can be used:
2760
2761@table @code
2762@item to-address
2763@cindex to-address
2764Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2765
2766@example
2767(to-address . "some@@where.com")
2768@end example
2769
2770This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2771lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2772the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2773ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2774that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2775
2776Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2777or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2778@samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2779the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2780group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2781list address instead.
2782
2783See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2784
2785@item to-list
2786@cindex to-list
2787Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2788
2789@example
2790(to-list . "some@@where.com")
2791@end example
2792
2793It is totally ignored
2794when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2795you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2796
2797If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2798@code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2799then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2800sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2801@vindex gnus-add-to-list
2802
2803@findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2804@cindex mail list groups
2805If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2806entering summary buffer.
2807
2808See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2809
2810@anchor{subscribed}
2811@item subscribed
2812@cindex subscribed
2813@cindex Mail-Followup-To
2814@findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2815If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2816to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2817mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2818(only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2819headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2820following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2821
2822@lisp
2823(setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2824 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2825@end lisp
2826
2827@xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2828a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2829
2830@item visible
2831@cindex visible
2832If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2833that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2834of whether it has any unread articles.
2835
2836This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2837@code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2838
2839@item broken-reply-to
2840@cindex broken-reply-to
2841Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2842headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2843if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2844can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2845has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2846itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2847
2848@item to-group
2849@cindex to-group
2850Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2851posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2852
2853@item newsgroup
2854@cindex newsgroup
2855If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2856will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2857This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2858news group.
2859
2860@item gcc-self
2861@cindex gcc-self
2862If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2863composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2864@code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2865generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2866be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2867precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2868(@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2869
2870@strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2871@code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2872doesn't accept articles.
2873
2874@item auto-expire
2875@cindex auto-expire
2876@cindex expiring mail
2877If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2878. t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2879alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2880
2881See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2882
2883@item total-expire
2884@cindex total-expire
2885@cindex expiring mail
2886If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2887@code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2888expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2889caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2890expiry.
2891
2892See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2893
2894@item expiry-wait
2895@cindex expiry-wait
2896@vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2897If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2898@code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2899@code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2900(@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2901can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2902symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2903
2904@item expiry-target
2905@cindex expiry-target
2906Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2907@code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2908
2909@item score-file
2910@cindex score file group parameter
2911Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2912@file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2913interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2914
2915@item adapt-file
2916@cindex adapt file group parameter
2917Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2918@file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2919All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2920
2921@item admin-address
2922@cindex admin-address
2923When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2924unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2925messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2926put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2927
2928@item display
2929@cindex display
2930Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2931display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2932
2933@table @code
2934@item all
2935Display all articles, both read and unread.
2936
2937@item an integer
2938Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2939entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2940
2941@item default
2942Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2943ticked articles.
2944
2945@item an array
2946Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2947
2948Here are some examples:
2949
2950@table @code
2951@item [unread]
2952Display only unread articles.
2953
2954@item [not expire]
2955Display everything except expirable articles.
2956
2957@item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2958Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2959responded to.
2960@end table
2961
2962The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2963Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2964@code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2965@code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2966@code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
2967
2968@end table
2969
2970The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2971the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2972command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2973
2974@item comment
2975@cindex comment
2976Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2977arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2978group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2979
2980@item charset
2981@cindex charset
2982Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2983@code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2984used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2985
2986See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
2987
2988@item ignored-charsets
2989@cindex ignored-charset
2990Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
2991will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
2992default charset will be used for decoding articles.
2993
2994See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
2995
2996@item posting-style
2997@cindex posting-style
2998You can store additional posting style information for this group
2999here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
3000@code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
3001the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
3002take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
3003
3004For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
3005instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
3006like this in the group parameters:
3007
3008@example
3009(posting-style
3010 (name "Funky Name")
3011 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
3012 (signature "Funky Signature"))
3013@end example
3014
01c52d31
MB
3015If you're using topics to organize your group buffer
3016(@pxref{Group Topics}), note that posting styles can also be set in
3017the topics parameters. Posting styles in topic parameters apply to all
3018groups in this topic. More precisely, the posting-style settings for a
3019group result from the hierarchical merging of all posting-style
3020entries in the parameters of this group and all the topics it belongs
3021to.
3022
3023
4009494e
GM
3024@item post-method
3025@cindex post-method
3026If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
3027instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
3028
3029@item banner
3030@cindex banner
3031An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
3032that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
3033@var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
3034last signature or any of the elements of the alist
3035@code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
3036
3037@item sieve
3038@cindex sieve
3039This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
3040that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
3041Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
3042condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
3043
3044For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
3045address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
3046translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
3047Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
3048
3049@example
01c52d31
MB
3050if address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com" @{
3051 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3052@}
3053@end example
3054
3055To generate tests for multiple email-addresses use a group parameter
3056like @code{(sieve address "sender" ("name@@one.org" else@@two.org"))}.
3057When generating a sieve script (@pxref{Sieve Commands}) Sieve code
3058like the following is generated:
3059
3060@example
3061if address "sender" ["name@@one.org", "else@@two.org"] @{
3062 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
4009494e
GM
3063@}
3064@end example
3065
01c52d31
MB
3066See @pxref{Sieve Commands} for commands and variables that might be of
3067interest in relation to the sieve parameter.
3068
4009494e
GM
3069The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3070Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3071
3072@item (agent parameters)
3073If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of the its parameters
3074to control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
3075Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3076agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3077minimize the configuration effort.
3078
3079@item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3080You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3081are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3082you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3083that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3084in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3085@code{eval}ed there.
3086
3087Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer.
3088But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3089message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3090message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3091question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3092Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3093parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
3094@file{~/.gnus} file:
3095
3096@lisp
3097(add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3098@end lisp
3099
3100@vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3101A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3102the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
3103
3104@example
3105nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3106@end example
3107
3108has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3109tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3110the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3111into the group parameters for the group.
3112
3113This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3114hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3115@code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group.
3116@code{dummy-variable} will be set to the (meaningless) result of the
3117@code{(ding)} form.
3118
3119Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3120pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3121following is added to a group parameter
3122
3123@lisp
3124(gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3125 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3126@end lisp
3127
3128when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3129expired.
3130
3131@end table
3132
3133Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
3134group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
3135presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
3136silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
3137parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
3138
3139@vindex gnus-parameters
3140Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3141But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3142case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3143For example:
3144
3145@lisp
3146(setq gnus-parameters
3147 '(("mail\\..*"
3148 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3149 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3150 (gnus-summary-line-format
3151 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3152 (gcc-self . t)
3153 (display . all))
3154
3155 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3156 (to-group . "\\1"))
3157
3158 ("mail\\.me"
3159 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3160
3161 ("list\\..*"
3162 (total-expire . t)
3163 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3164@end lisp
3165
3166String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
3167the @code{to-group} example shows.
3168
3169@vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3170By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3171specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3172or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3173@code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3174value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3175example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3176applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3177group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3178value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3179@code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3180always in a case-insensitive manner.
3181
01c52d31
MB
3182You can define different sorting to different groups via
3183@code{gnus-parameters}. Here is an example to sort an @acronym{NNTP}
3184group by reverse date to see the latest news at the top and an
3185@acronym{RSS} group by subject. In this example, the first group is the
3186Debian daily news group @code{gmane.linux.debian.user.news} from
3187news.gmane.org. The @acronym{RSS} group corresponds to the Debian
3188weekly news RSS feed
3189@url{http://packages.debian.org/unstable/newpkg_main.en.rdf},
3190@xref{RSS}.
3191
3192@lisp
3193(setq
3194 gnus-parameters
3195 '(("nntp.*gmane\\.debian\\.user\\.news"
3196 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3197 (gnus-article-sort-functions '((not gnus-article-sort-by-date)))
3198 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3199 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
3200 ("nnrss.*debian"
3201 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3202 (gnus-article-sort-functions 'gnus-article-sort-by-subject)
3203 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3204 (gnus-use-scoring t)
3205 (gnus-score-find-score-files-function 'gnus-score-find-single)
3206 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%d %I%(%[ %s %]%)\n"))))
3207@end lisp
3208
4009494e
GM
3209
3210@node Listing Groups
3211@section Listing Groups
3212@cindex group listing
3213
3214These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3215
3216@table @kbd
3217
3218@item l
3219@itemx A s
3220@kindex A s (Group)
3221@kindex l (Group)
3222@findex gnus-group-list-groups
3223List all groups that have unread articles
3224(@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3225command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3226only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3227@code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3228groups).
3229
3230@item L
3231@itemx A u
3232@kindex A u (Group)
3233@kindex L (Group)
3234@findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3235List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3236(@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3237this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3238it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3239unsubscribed groups).
3240
3241@item A l
3242@kindex A l (Group)
3243@findex gnus-group-list-level
3244List all unread groups on a specific level
3245(@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3246with no unread articles.
3247
3248@item A k
3249@kindex A k (Group)
3250@findex gnus-group-list-killed
3251List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3252prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3253currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3254from the server.
3255
3256@item A z
3257@kindex A z (Group)
3258@findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3259List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3260
3261@item A m
3262@kindex A m (Group)
3263@findex gnus-group-list-matching
3264List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3265(@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3266
3267@item A M
3268@kindex A M (Group)
3269@findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3270List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3271
3272@item A A
3273@kindex A A (Group)
3274@findex gnus-group-list-active
3275List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3276server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3277might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3278to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3279thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3280don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3281Take the output with some grains of salt.
3282
3283@item A a
3284@kindex A a (Group)
3285@findex gnus-group-apropos
3286List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3287(@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3288
3289@item A d
3290@kindex A d (Group)
3291@findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3292List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3293(@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3294
3295@item A c
3296@kindex A c (Group)
3297@findex gnus-group-list-cached
3298List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3299
3300@item A ?
3301@kindex A ? (Group)
3302@findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3303List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3304
3305@item A /
3306@kindex A / (Group)
3307@findex gnus-group-list-limit
3308List groups limited within the current selection
3309(@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3310
3311@item A f
3312@kindex A f (Group)
3313@findex gnus-group-list-flush
3314Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3315
3316@item A p
3317@kindex A p (Group)
3318@findex gnus-group-list-plus
3319List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3320
3321@end table
3322
3323@vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3324@cindex visible group parameter
3325Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3326always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3327add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3328get the same effect.
3329
3330@vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3331Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3332group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3333@code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3334groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3335
3336
3337@node Sorting Groups
3338@section Sorting Groups
3339@cindex sorting groups
3340
3341@kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3342@findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3343@vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3344The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3345group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3346@code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3347include:
3348
3349@table @code
3350
3351@item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3352@findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3353Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3354
3355@item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3356@findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3357Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3358
3359@item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3360@findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3361Sort by group level.
3362
3363@item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3364@findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3365Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3366
3367@item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3368@findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3369Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3370are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3371
3372@item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3373@findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3374Sort by number of unread articles.
3375
3376@item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3377@findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3378Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3379
3380@item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3381@findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3382Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3383
3384
3385@end table
3386
3387@code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3388functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3389the last one.
3390
3391
3392There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3393some sorting criteria:
3394
3395@table @kbd
3396@item G S a
3397@kindex G S a (Group)
3398@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3399Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3400(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3401
3402@item G S u
3403@kindex G S u (Group)
3404@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3405Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3406(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3407
3408@item G S l
3409@kindex G S l (Group)
3410@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3411Sort the group buffer by group level
3412(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3413
3414@item G S v
3415@kindex G S v (Group)
3416@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3417Sort the group buffer by group score
3418(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3419
3420@item G S r
3421@kindex G S r (Group)
3422@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3423Sort the group buffer by group rank
3424(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3425
3426@item G S m
3427@kindex G S m (Group)
3428@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3429Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3430(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3431
3432@item G S n
3433@kindex G S n (Group)
3434@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3435Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3436(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3437
3438@end table
3439
3440All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3441(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3442
3443When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3444commands will sort in reverse order.
3445
3446You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3447
3448@table @kbd
3449@item G P a
3450@kindex G P a (Group)
3451@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3452Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3453(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3454
3455@item G P u
3456@kindex G P u (Group)
3457@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3458Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3459(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3460
3461@item G P l
3462@kindex G P l (Group)
3463@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3464Sort the groups by group level
3465(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3466
3467@item G P v
3468@kindex G P v (Group)
3469@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3470Sort the groups by group score
3471(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3472
3473@item G P r
3474@kindex G P r (Group)
3475@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3476Sort the groups by group rank
3477(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3478
3479@item G P m
3480@kindex G P m (Group)
3481@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3482Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3483(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3484
3485@item G P n
3486@kindex G P n (Group)
3487@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3488Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3489(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3490
3491@item G P s
3492@kindex G P s (Group)
3493@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3494Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3495
3496@end table
3497
3498And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3499move groups around.
3500
3501
3502@node Group Maintenance
3503@section Group Maintenance
3504@cindex bogus groups
3505
3506@table @kbd
3507@item b
3508@kindex b (Group)
3509@findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3510Find bogus groups and delete them
3511(@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3512
3513@item F
3514@kindex F (Group)
3515@findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3516Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3517With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3518for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3519to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3520zombies.
3521
3522@item C-c C-x
3523@kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3524@findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3525@cindex expiring mail
3526Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3527process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3528all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3529(@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3530
3531@item C-c C-M-x
3532@kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3533@findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3534@cindex expiring mail
3535Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3536(@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3537
3538@end table
3539
3540
3541@node Browse Foreign Server
3542@section Browse Foreign Server
3543@cindex foreign servers
3544@cindex browsing servers
3545
3546@table @kbd
3547@item B
3548@kindex B (Group)
3549@findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3550You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3551then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3552(@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3553@end table
3554
3555@findex gnus-browse-mode
3556A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3557will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3558a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3559
3560Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3561
3562@table @kbd
3563@item n
3564@kindex n (Browse)
3565@findex gnus-group-next-group
3566Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3567
3568@item p
3569@kindex p (Browse)
3570@findex gnus-group-prev-group
3571Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3572
3573@item SPACE
3574@kindex SPACE (Browse)
3575@findex gnus-browse-read-group
3576Enter the current group and display the first article
3577(@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3578
3579@item RET
3580@kindex RET (Browse)
3581@findex gnus-browse-select-group
3582Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3583
3584@item u
3585@kindex u (Browse)
3586@findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3587Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3588subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3589
3590@item l
3591@itemx q
3592@kindex q (Browse)
3593@kindex l (Browse)
3594@findex gnus-browse-exit
3595Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3596
3597@item d
3598@kindex d (Browse)
3599@findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3600Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3601
3602@item ?
3603@kindex ? (Browse)
3604@findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3605Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3606there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3607@end table
3608
3609
3610@node Exiting Gnus
3611@section Exiting Gnus
3612@cindex exiting Gnus
3613
3614Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3615
3616@table @kbd
3617@item z
3618@kindex z (Group)
3619@findex gnus-group-suspend
3620Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3621but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3622is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3623
3624@item q
3625@kindex q (Group)
3626@findex gnus-group-exit
3627@c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3628Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3629
3630@item Q
3631@kindex Q (Group)
3632@findex gnus-group-quit
3633Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3634The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3635@end table
3636
3637@vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3638@vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3639@vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3640@code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3641@code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3642@code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3643exiting Gnus.
3644
3645Note:
3646
3647@quotation
3648Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3649numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3650behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3651plastic chair.
3652@end quotation
3653
3654
3655@node Group Topics
3656@section Group Topics
3657@cindex topics
3658
3659If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3660them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3661here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3662you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3663even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3664groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3665
3666@iftex
3667@iflatex
3668\gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3669\put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3670}
3671@end iflatex
3672@end iftex
3673
3674Here's an example:
3675
3676@example
3677Gnus
3678 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3679 3: comp.emacs
3680 2: alt.religion.emacs
3681 Naughty Emacs
3682 452: alt.sex.emacs
3683 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3684 Misc
3685 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3686 13: comp.sources.unix
3687@end example
3688
3689@findex gnus-topic-mode
3690@kindex t (Group)
3691To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3692@code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3693is a toggling command.)
3694
3695Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3696dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3697Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3698under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3699Hot and bothered?
3700
3701If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3702the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3703@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3704
3705@lisp
3706(add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3707@end lisp
3708
3709@menu
3710* Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3711* Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3712* Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3713* Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3714* Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3715@end menu
3716
3717
3718@node Topic Commands
3719@subsection Topic Commands
3720@cindex topic commands
3721
3722When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3723available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3724definitions slightly.
3725
3726In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3727First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3728groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3729like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3730shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3731groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3732
3733Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3734the way you like.
3735
3736@table @kbd
3737
3738@item T n
3739@kindex T n (Topic)
3740@findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3741Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3742(@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3743
3744@item T TAB
3745@itemx TAB
3746@kindex T TAB (Topic)
3747@kindex TAB (Topic)
3748@findex gnus-topic-indent
3749``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3750previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3751``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3752
3753@item M-TAB
3754@kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3755@findex gnus-topic-unindent
3756``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3757parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3758
3759@end table
3760
3761The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3762They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3763@kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3764kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3765
3766@table @kbd
3767
3768@item C-k
3769@kindex C-k (Topic)
3770@findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3771Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3772topic will be removed along with the topic.
3773
3774@item C-y
3775@kindex C-y (Topic)
3776@findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3777Yank the previously killed group or topic
3778(@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3779before all groups.
3780
3781So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3782@kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3783move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3784topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3785paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3786
3787You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3788you can move topics around as well as groups.
3789
3790@end table
3791
3792After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3793hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3794key.
3795
3796@table @kbd
3797
3798@item RET
3799@kindex RET (Topic)
3800@findex gnus-topic-select-group
3801@itemx SPACE
3802Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3803When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3804usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3805visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3806toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3807prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3808
3809@end table
3810
3811Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3812
3813@table @kbd
3814
3815@item T m
3816@kindex T m (Topic)
3817@findex gnus-topic-move-group
3818Move the current group to some other topic
3819(@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3820convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3821
3822@item T j
3823@kindex T j (Topic)
3824@findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3825Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3826
3827@item T c
3828@kindex T c (Topic)
3829@findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3830Copy the current group to some other topic
3831(@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3832convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3833
3834@item T h
3835@kindex T h (Topic)
3836@findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3837Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3838a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3839
3840@item T s
3841@kindex T s (Topic)
3842@findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3843Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3844a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3845
3846@item T D
3847@kindex T D (Topic)
3848@findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3849Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3850This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3851topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3852remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3853the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3854(which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3855topic.
3856
3857This command uses the process/prefix convention
3858(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3859
3860@item T M
3861@kindex T M (Topic)
3862@findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3863Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3864(@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3865
3866@item T C
3867@kindex T C (Topic)
3868@findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3869Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3870(@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3871
3872@item T H
3873@kindex T H (Topic)
3874@findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3875Toggle hiding empty topics
3876(@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3877
3878@item T #
3879@kindex T # (Topic)
3880@findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3881Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3882(@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3883sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3884
3885@item T M-#
3886@kindex T M-# (Topic)
3887@findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3888Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3889(@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3890sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3891
3892@item C-c C-x
3893@kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3894@findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3895@cindex expiring mail
3896Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3897expiry process (if any)
3898(@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3899
3900@item T r
3901@kindex T r (Topic)
3902@findex gnus-topic-rename
3903Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3904
3905@item T DEL
3906@kindex T DEL (Topic)
3907@findex gnus-topic-delete
3908Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3909
3910@item A T
3911@kindex A T (Topic)
3912@findex gnus-topic-list-active
3913List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3914(@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3915
3916@item T M-n
3917@kindex T M-n (Topic)
3918@findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3919Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3920
3921@item T M-p
3922@kindex T M-p (Topic)
3923@findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
01c52d31 3924Go to the previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
4009494e
GM
3925
3926@item G p
3927@kindex G p (Topic)
3928@findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3929@cindex group parameters
3930@cindex topic parameters
3931@cindex parameters
3932Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3933@xref{Topic Parameters}.
3934
3935@end table
3936
3937
3938@node Topic Variables
3939@subsection Topic Variables
3940@cindex topic variables
3941
3942The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3943This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3944
3945@vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3946The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3947@code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3948Valid elements are:
3949
3950@table @samp
3951@item i
3952Indentation.
3953@item n
3954Topic name.
3955@item v
3956Visibility.
3957@item l
3958Level.
3959@item g
3960Number of groups in the topic.
3961@item a
3962Number of unread articles in the topic.
3963@item A
3964Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3965@end table
3966
3967@vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3968Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3969@code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3970The default is 2.
3971
3972@vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3973@code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3974
3975@vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3976The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3977topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3978
3979
3980@node Topic Sorting
3981@subsection Topic Sorting
3982@cindex topic sorting
3983
3984You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3985commands:
3986
3987
3988@table @kbd
3989@item T S a
3990@kindex T S a (Topic)
3991@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3992Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3993(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3994
3995@item T S u
3996@kindex T S u (Topic)
3997@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3998Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3999(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
4000
4001@item T S l
4002@kindex T S l (Topic)
4003@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
4004Sort the current topic by group level
4005(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
4006
4007@item T S v
4008@kindex T S v (Topic)
4009@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
4010Sort the current topic by group score
4011(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
4012
4013@item T S r
4014@kindex T S r (Topic)
4015@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
4016Sort the current topic by group rank
4017(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
4018
4019@item T S m
4020@kindex T S m (Topic)
4021@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
4022Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
4023(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
4024
4025@item T S e
4026@kindex T S e (Topic)
4027@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
4028Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
4029(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
4030
4031@item T S s
4032@kindex T S s (Topic)
4033@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
4034Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
4035@code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
4036(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
4037
4038@end table
4039
4040When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
4041order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
4042sorting.
4043
4044
4045@node Topic Topology
4046@subsection Topic Topology
4047@cindex topic topology
4048@cindex topology
4049
4050So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
4051
4052@example
4053@group
4054Gnus
4055 Emacs -- I wuw it!
4056 3: comp.emacs
4057 2: alt.religion.emacs
4058 Naughty Emacs
4059 452: alt.sex.emacs
4060 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4061 Misc
4062 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4063 13: comp.sources.unix
4064@end group
4065@end example
4066
4067So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
4068that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
4069just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
4070follows:
4071
4072@lisp
4073(("Gnus" visible)
4074 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
4075 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
4076 (("Misc" visible)))
4077@end lisp
4078
4079@vindex gnus-topic-topology
4080This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
4081for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
4082file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
4083to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
4084setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
4085
4086This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
4087and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
4088allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
4089
4090
4091@node Topic Parameters
4092@subsection Topic Parameters
4093@cindex topic parameters
4094
4095All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4096(and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4097topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4098enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4099Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4100
4101In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4102parameters:
4103
4104@table @code
4105@item subscribe
4106When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4107@code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4108value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4109topic.
4110
4111@item subscribe-level
4112When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4113the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4114@code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4115
4116@end table
4117
4118Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4119parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4120know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4121verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4122
4123@example
4124@group
4125Gnus
4126 Emacs
4127 3: comp.emacs
4128 2: alt.religion.emacs
4129 452: alt.sex.emacs
4130 Relief
4131 452: alt.sex.emacs
4132 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4133 Misc
4134 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4135 13: comp.sources.unix
4136 452: alt.sex.emacs
4137@end group
4138@end example
4139
4140The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4141. "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4142@code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4143topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4144@* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4145. "religion.SCORE")}.
4146
4147Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4148will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4149group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4150score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4151get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4152
4153This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4154there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4155parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4156@code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4157gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4158of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4159happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4160happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4161
4162
01c52d31
MB
4163@node Non-ASCII Group Names
4164@section Accessing groups of non-English names
4165@cindex non-ascii group names
4166
4167There are some news servers that provide groups of which the names are
4168expressed with their native languages in the world. For instance, in a
4169certain news server there are some newsgroups of which the names are
4170spelled in Chinese, where people are talking in Chinese. You can, of
4171course, subscribe to such news groups using Gnus. Currently Gnus
4172supports non-@acronym{ASCII} group names not only with the @code{nntp}
4173back end but also with the @code{nnml} back end and the @code{nnrss}
4174back end.
4175
4176Every such group name is encoded by a certain charset in the server
4177side (in an @acronym{NNTP} server its administrator determines the
4178charset, but for groups in the other back ends it is determined by you).
4179Gnus has to display the decoded ones for you in the group buffer and the
4180article buffer, and needs to use the encoded ones when communicating
4181with servers. However, Gnus doesn't know what charset is used for each
4182non-@acronym{ASCII} group name. The following two variables are just
4183the ones for telling Gnus what charset should be used for each group:
4184
4185@table @code
4186@item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4187@vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4188An alist of select methods and charsets. The default value is
4189@code{nil}. The names of groups in the server specified by that select
4190method are all supposed to use the corresponding charset. For example:
4191
4192@lisp
4193(setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4194 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4195@end lisp
4196
4197Charsets specified for groups with this variable are preferred to the
4198ones specified for the same groups with the
4199@code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} variable (see below).
4200
4201A select method can be very long, like:
4202
4203@lisp
4204(nntp "gmane"
4205 (nntp-address "news.gmane.org")
4206 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
4207 (nntp-open-connection-function
4208 nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
4209 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
4210 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
4211 ("-C" "-t" "-e" "none"))
4212 (nntp-via-address @dots{}))
4213@end lisp
4214
4215In that case, you can truncate it into @code{(nntp "gmane")} in this
4216variable. That is, it is enough to contain only the back end name and
4217the server name.
4218
4219@item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4220@cindex UTF-8 group names
4221@vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4222An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
4223@code{((".*" . utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported,
4224otherwise the default is @code{nil}. For example:
4225
4226@lisp
4227(setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4228 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)
4229 (".*" . utf-8)))
4230@end lisp
4231
4232Note that this variable is ignored if the match is made with
4233@code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist}.
4234@end table
4235
4236Those two variables are used also to determine the charset for encoding
4237and decoding non-@acronym{ASCII} group names that are in the back ends
4238other than @code{nntp}. It means that it is you who determine it. If
4239you do nothing, the charset used for group names in those back ends will
4240all be @code{utf-8} because of the last element of
4241@code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4242
4243There is one more important variable for non-@acronym{ASCII} group
4244names. @emph{XEmacs users must set this}. Emacs users necessarily need
4245not do:
4246
4247@table @code
4248@item nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4249The value of this variable should be a coding system or @code{nil}
4250(which is the default). The @code{nnml} back end, the @code{nnrss} back
4251end, the @acronym{NNTP} marks feature (@pxref{NNTP marks}), the agent,
4252and the cache use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names in those files and
4253directories. This variable overrides the value of
4254@code{file-name-coding-system} which specifies the coding system used
4255when encoding and decoding those file names and directory names.
4256
4257In XEmacs (with the @code{mule} feature), @code{file-name-coding-system}
4258is the only means to specify the coding system used to encode and decode
4259file names. Therefore, @emph{you, XEmacs users, have to set it} to the
4260coding system that is suitable to encode and decode non-@acronym{ASCII}
4261group names. On the other hand, Emacs uses the value of
4262@code{default-file-name-coding-system} if @code{file-name-coding-system}
4263is @code{nil}. Normally the value of
4264@code{default-file-name-coding-system} is initialized according to the
4265locale, so you will need to do nothing if the value is suitable to
4266encode and decode non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4267
4268The value of this variable (or @code{default-file-name-coding-system})
4269does not necessarily need to be the same value that is determined by
4270@code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} and
4271@code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4272
4273If you want to subscribe to the groups spelled in Chinese but
4274@code{default-file-name-coding-system} is initialized by default to
4275@code{iso-latin-1} for example, that is the most typical case where you
4276have to set @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} even if you are an
4277Emacs user. The @code{utf-8} coding system is a good candidate for it.
4278Otherwise, you may change the locale in your system so that
4279@code{default-file-name-coding-system} may be initialized to an
4280appropriate value, instead of specifying this variable.
4281@end table
4282
4283Note that when you copy or move articles from a non-@acronym{ASCII}
4284group to another group, the charset used to encode and decode group
4285names should be the same in both groups. Otherwise the Newsgroups
4286header will be displayed incorrectly in the article buffer.
4287
4288
4009494e
GM
4289@node Misc Group Stuff
4290@section Misc Group Stuff
4291
4292@menu
4293* Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4294* Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4295* Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4296* File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4297* Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4298@end menu
4299
4300@table @kbd
4301
4302@item v
4303@kindex v (Group)
4304@cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4305The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4306command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4307
4308@lisp
4309(define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4310 (lambda ()
4311 (interactive)
4312 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4313@end lisp
4314
4315On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4316@xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
4317
4318@item ^
4319@kindex ^ (Group)
4320@findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4321Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4322@xref{Server Buffer}.
4323
4324@item a
4325@kindex a (Group)
4326@findex gnus-group-post-news
4327Start composing a message (a news by default)
4328(@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4329under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4330Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4331article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4332with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4333
4334@item m
4335@kindex m (Group)
4336@findex gnus-group-mail
4337Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4338use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4339prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4340@xref{Composing Messages}.
4341
4342@item i
4343@kindex i (Group)
4344@findex gnus-group-news
4345Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4346post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4347for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4348
4349This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4350This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4351sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4352in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4353for this to work though.
4354
01c52d31
MB
4355@item G z
4356@kindex G z (Group)
4357@findex gnus-group-compact-group
4358
4359Compact the group under point (@code{gnus-group-compact-group}).
4360Currently implemented only in nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes
4361gaps between article numbers, hence getting a correct total article
4362count.
4363
4009494e
GM
4364@end table
4365
4366Variables for the group buffer:
4367
4368@table @code
4369
4370@item gnus-group-mode-hook
4371@vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4372is called after the group buffer has been
4373created.
4374
4375@item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4376@vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4377is called after the group buffer is
4378generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4379unnatural way.
4380
4381@item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4382@vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4383is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4384generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4385
4386@item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4387@vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4388Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4389whether they are empty or not.
4390
4009494e
GM
4391@end table
4392
4393@node Scanning New Messages
4394@subsection Scanning New Messages
4395@cindex new messages
4396@cindex scanning new news
4397
4398@table @kbd
4399
4400@item g
4401@kindex g (Group)
4402@findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4403@c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4404Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4405this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4406(@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4407command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4408back end(s).
4409
4410@item M-g
4411@kindex M-g (Group)
4412@findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4413@vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4414@c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4415Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4416(@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4417@code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4418to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4419
4420@findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4421@cindex activating groups
4422@item C-c M-g
4423@kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4424Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4425
4426@item R
4427@kindex R (Group)
4428@cindex restarting
4429@findex gnus-group-restart
4430Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4431file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4432Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4433
4434@end table
4435
4436@vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4437@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4438
4439@vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4440@code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4441news.
4442
4443
4444@node Group Information
4445@subsection Group Information
4446@cindex group information
4447@cindex information on groups
4448
4449@table @kbd
4450
4451
4452@item H f
4453@kindex H f (Group)
4454@findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
4455@vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
4456@cindex FAQ
4457@cindex ange-ftp
4458Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} for the current group
4459(@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the @acronym{FAQ}
4460from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on
4461a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
4462In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
4463between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be
4464used for fetching the file.
4465
4466If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
4467through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
4468
4469@item H c
4470@kindex H c (Group)
4471@findex gnus-group-fetch-charter
4472@vindex gnus-group-charter-alist
4473@cindex charter
4474Try to open the charter for the current group in a web browser
4475(@code{gnus-group-fetch-charter}). Query for a group if given a
4476prefix argument.
4477
4478Gnus will use @code{gnus-group-charter-alist} to find the location of
4479the charter. If no location is known, Gnus will fetch the control
4480messages for the group, which in some cases includes the charter.
4481
4482@item H C
4483@kindex H C (Group)
4484@findex gnus-group-fetch-control
4485@vindex gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url
4486@cindex control message
4487Fetch the control messages for the group from the archive at
4488@code{ftp.isc.org} (@code{gnus-group-fetch-control}). Query for a
4489group if given a prefix argument.
4490
4491If @code{gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url} is non-@code{nil},
4492Gnus will open the control messages in a browser using
4493@code{browse-url}. Otherwise they are fetched using @code{ange-ftp}
4494and displayed in an ephemeral group.
4495
4496Note that the control messages are compressed. To use this command
4497you need to turn on @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed
4498Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
4499
4500@item H d
4501@itemx C-c C-d
4502@c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4503@kindex H d (Group)
4504@kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4505@cindex describing groups
4506@cindex group description
4507@findex gnus-group-describe-group
4508Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4509a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4510
4511@item M-d
4512@kindex M-d (Group)
4513@findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4514Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4515prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4516
4517@item H v
4518@itemx V
4519@kindex V (Group)
4520@kindex H v (Group)
4521@cindex version
4522@findex gnus-version
4523Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4524
4525@item ?
4526@kindex ? (Group)
4527@findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4528Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4529
4530@item C-c C-i
4531@kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4532@cindex info
4533@cindex manual
4534@findex gnus-info-find-node
4535Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4536@end table
4537
4538
4539@node Group Timestamp
4540@subsection Group Timestamp
4541@cindex timestamps
4542@cindex group timestamps
4543
4544It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4545group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4546@code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4547
4548@lisp
4549(add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4550@end lisp
4551
4552After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4553
4554This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4555use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4556
4557@lisp
4558(setq gnus-group-line-format
4559 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4560@end lisp
4561
4562This will result in lines looking like:
4563
4564@example
4565* 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4566 0: custom 19961002T012713
4567@end example
4568
4569As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4570may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4571something like:
4572
4573@lisp
4574(setq gnus-group-line-format
4575 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4576@end lisp
4577
4578If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4579user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4580trick:
4581
4582@lisp
4583(setq gnus-group-line-format
4584 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4585(defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4586 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4587 (if time
4588 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4589 "")))
4590@end lisp
4591
4592
4593@node File Commands
4594@subsection File Commands
4595@cindex file commands
4596
4597@table @kbd
4598
4599@item r
4600@kindex r (Group)
4601@findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4602@vindex gnus-init-file
4603@cindex reading init file
4604Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4605@file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4606
4607@item s
4608@kindex s (Group)
4609@findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4610@cindex saving .newsrc
4611Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4612(@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4613file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4614
4615@c @item Z
4616@c @kindex Z (Group)
4617@c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4618@c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4619
4620@end table
4621
4622
4623@node Sieve Commands
4624@subsection Sieve Commands
4625@cindex group sieve commands
4626
4627Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4628the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4629sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4630commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4631script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
4632
4633@vindex gnus-sieve-file
4634@vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4635@vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4636The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4637default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4638between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4639@code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4640outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4641regenerate the Sieve script.
4642
4643@vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4644The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4645is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4646placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4647is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4648example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4649"owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4650code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4651@code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4652except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4653
4654@example
4655if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4656 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4657 stop;
4658@}
4659@end example
4660
4661@xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4662
4663@table @kbd
4664
4665@item D g
4666@kindex D g (Group)
4667@findex gnus-sieve-generate
4668@vindex gnus-sieve-file
4669@cindex generating sieve script
4670Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4671put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4672
4673@item D u
4674@kindex D u (Group)
4675@findex gnus-sieve-update
4676@vindex gnus-sieve-file
4677@cindex updating sieve script
4678Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4679@code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4680server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4681
4682@end table
4683
4684
4685@node Summary Buffer
4686@chapter Summary Buffer
4687@cindex summary buffer
4688
4689A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4690move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4691
4692The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4693group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4694
4695You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4696
4697You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4698customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4699available in Emacs.
4700
4701@kindex v (Summary)
4702@cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4703The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4704command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4705@lisp
4706(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4707@end lisp
4708
4709@menu
4710* Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4711* Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4712* Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4713* Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4714* Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4715* Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4716* Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4717* Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4718* Threading:: How threads are made.
4719* Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4720* Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4721* Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4722* Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
01c52d31 4723* Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4009494e
GM
4724* Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4725* Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4726* Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4727* Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4728* MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4729* Charsets:: Character set issues.
4730* Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4731* Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4732* Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4733* Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4734* Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4735* Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4736* Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4737* Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4738 or reselecting the current group.
4739* Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4740* Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4741* Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4742* Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4743@end menu
4744
4745
4746@node Summary Buffer Format
4747@section Summary Buffer Format
4748@cindex summary buffer format
4749
4750@iftex
4751@iflatex
4752\gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4753\put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4754\put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4755}
4756@end iflatex
4757@end iftex
4758
4759@menu
4760* Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4761* To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4762* Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4763* Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4764@end menu
4765
4766@findex mail-extract-address-components
4767@findex gnus-extract-address-components
4768@vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4769Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4770variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4771@code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4772@code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4773fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4774@code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4775slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4776cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4777
4778@lisp
4779(setq gnus-extract-address-components
4780 'mail-extract-address-components)
4781@end lisp
4782
4783@vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4784@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4785article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4786with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4787
4788
4789@node Summary Buffer Lines
4790@subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4791
4792@vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4793You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4794the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4795lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4796(@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4797
4798There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4799the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4800performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4801possible to change this. Just write a new function
4802@code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4803@xref{Positioning Point}.
4804
4805The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4806
4807The following format specification characters and extended format
4808specification(s) are understood:
4809
4810@table @samp
4811@item N
4812Article number.
4813@item S
4814Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4815@code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4816@item s
4817Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4818had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4819(@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4820@item F
4821Full @code{From} header.
4822@item n
4823The name (from the @code{From} header).
4824@item f
4825The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4826From Newsgroups}).
4827@item a
4828The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4829spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4830@code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4831may be more thorough.
4832@item A
4833The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4834the @code{a} spec.
4835@item L
4836Number of lines in the article.
4837@item c
4838Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4839in some methods (like nnfolder).
4840@item k
4841Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4842for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4843@item I
4844Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4845@item B
4846A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4847lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4848
4849@example
4850>
4851+->
4852| +->
4853| | \->
4854| | \->
4855| \->
4856+->
4857\->
4858@end example
4859
4860You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4861that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4862replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4863line-drawing glyphs.
4864@table @code
4865@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4866@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4867Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4868instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4869
4870@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4871@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4872Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4873@code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4874
4875@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4876@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4877Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4878instead. The default is @samp{}.
4879
4880@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4881@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4882Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4883
4884@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4885@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4886Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4887
4888@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4889@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4890Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4891
4892@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4893@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4894Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4895
4896@end table
4897
4898@item T
4899Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4900pushes everything after it off the screen).
4901@item [
4902Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4903for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4904@item ]
4905Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4906for adopted articles.
4907@item >
4908One space for each thread level.
4909@item <
4910Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4911@item U
4912Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4913
4914@item R
4915This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4916mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4917or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4918
4919@item i
4920Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4921@item z
4922@vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4923Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4924default level. If the difference between
4925@code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4926@code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4927@item V
4928Total thread score.
4929@item x
4930@code{Xref}.
4931@item D
4932@code{Date}.
4933@item d
4934The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4935@item o
4936The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4937@item M
4938@code{Message-ID}.
4939@item r
4940@code{References}.
4941@item t
4942Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4943down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4944@item e
4945An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4946article has any children.
4947@item P
4948The line number.
4949@item O
4950Download mark.
4951@item *
4952Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4953@item &user-date;
4954Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4955@code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4956@item u
4957User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4958be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4959@code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4960following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4961argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4962into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4963@end table
4964
4965Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4966@code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4967There can only be one such area.
4968
4969The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4970have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4971compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4972that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4973variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4974buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4975
4976The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4977(Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4978
4979This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4980
4981
4982@node To From Newsgroups
4983@subsection To From Newsgroups
4984@cindex To
4985@cindex Newsgroups
4986
4987In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4988isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4989you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4990headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4991gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4992
4993@enumerate
4994@item
4995@vindex gnus-extra-headers
4996The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4997@code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4998instance:
4999
5000@lisp
5001(setq gnus-extra-headers
5002 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
5003@end lisp
5004
5005This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
5006storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
5007
5008@item
5009@findex gnus-extra-header
5010The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
5011@code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
5012access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
5013
5014@example
5015"%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
5016@end example
5017
5018@item
5019@vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5020The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
5021summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
5022@code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
5023@code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
5024headers are used instead.
5025
01c52d31
MB
5026To distinguish regular articles from those where the @code{From} field
5027has been swapped, a string is prefixed to the @code{To} or
5028@code{Newsgroups} header in the summary line. By default the string is
5029@samp{-> } for @code{To} and @samp{=> } for @code{Newsgroups}, you can
5030customize these strings with @code{gnus-summary-to-prefix} and
5031@code{gnus-summary-newsgroup-prefix}.
5032
4009494e
GM
5033@end enumerate
5034
5035@vindex nnmail-extra-headers
5036A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
5037to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
5038If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
5039changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
5040and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
5041regeneration.
5042
5043@vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5044You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
5045@code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
5046@code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
5047
5048In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
5049@file{~/.gnus.el}:
5050
5051@lisp
5052(setq gnus-extra-headers
5053 '(To Newsgroups))
5054(setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
5055(setq gnus-summary-line-format
5056 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
5057(setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5058 "Your Name Here")
5059@end lisp
5060
5061(The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
5062to fit your needs.)
5063
5064A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
5065convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
5066support:
5067
5068The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
5069the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
5070nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
5071
5072@example
5073Newsgroups:full
5074@end example
5075
5076to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
5077as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
5078
5079
5080@node Summary Buffer Mode Line
5081@subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
5082
5083@vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
5084You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
5085Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
5086like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
5087
5088Here are the elements you can play with:
5089
5090@table @samp
5091@item G
5092Group name.
5093@item p
5094Unprefixed group name.
5095@item A
5096Current article number.
5097@item z
5098Current article score.
5099@item V
5100Gnus version.
5101@item U
5102Number of unread articles in this group.
5103@item e
5104Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
5105summary buffer.
5106@item Z
5107A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
5108either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
5109articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
5110and no unselected ones.
5111@item g
5112Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
5113shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
5114@item S
5115Subject of the current article.
5116@item u
5117User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
5118@item s
5119Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
5120@item d
5121Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5122@item t
5123Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5124@item r
5125Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
5126@item E
5127Number of articles expunged by the score files.
5128@end table
5129
5130
5131@node Summary Highlighting
5132@subsection Summary Highlighting
5133
5134@table @code
5135
5136@item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5137@vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5138This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
5139highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
5140@code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5141
5142@item gnus-summary-update-hook
5143@vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
5144This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
5145@code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5146
5147@item gnus-summary-selected-face
5148@vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
5149This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
5150highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
5151
5152@item gnus-summary-highlight
5153@vindex gnus-summary-highlight
5154Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
5155list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
5156. @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
5157italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
5158to something like
5159@lisp
5160(((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
5161 ((> score default) . bold))
5162@end lisp
5163As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
5164@var{face} will be applied to the line.
5165@end table
5166
5167
5168@node Summary Maneuvering
5169@section Summary Maneuvering
5170@cindex summary movement
5171
5172All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
5173behave pretty much as you'd expect.
5174
5175None of these commands select articles.
5176
5177@table @kbd
5178@item G M-n
5179@itemx M-n
5180@kindex M-n (Summary)
5181@kindex G M-n (Summary)
5182@findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
5183Go to the next summary line of an unread article
5184(@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
5185
5186@item G M-p
5187@itemx M-p
5188@kindex M-p (Summary)
5189@kindex G M-p (Summary)
5190@findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
5191Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
5192(@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
5193
5194@item G g
5195@kindex G g (Summary)
5196@findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
5197Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
5198without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
5199@end table
5200
5201If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
5202can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
5203buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
5204to the group buffer.
5205
5206Variables related to summary movement:
5207
5208@table @code
5209
5210@vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5211@item gnus-auto-select-next
5212If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5213no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5214the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5215empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5216this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
5217next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
5218is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
5219confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
5220will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
5221Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
5222command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
5223@pxref{Group Levels}.
5224
5225@item gnus-auto-select-same
5226@vindex gnus-auto-select-same
5227If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
5228article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
5229mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
5230for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
5231articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
5232
5233This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
5234
5235@item gnus-summary-check-current
5236@vindex gnus-summary-check-current
5237If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
5238to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
5239Instead, they will choose the current article.
5240
5241@item gnus-auto-center-summary
5242@vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5243If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5244centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5245slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5246set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5247action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5248buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5249threads.
5250
5251This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5252the given number of lines from the top.
5253
5254@end table
5255
5256
5257@node Choosing Articles
5258@section Choosing Articles
5259@cindex selecting articles
5260
5261@menu
5262* Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5263* Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5264@end menu
5265
5266
5267@node Choosing Commands
5268@subsection Choosing Commands
5269
5270None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5271and they all select and display an article.
5272
5273If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5274@ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
5275
5276@table @kbd
5277@item SPACE
5278@kindex SPACE (Summary)
5279@findex gnus-summary-next-page
5280Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5281unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5282
5283If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5284again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5285@kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5286
5287@item G n
5288@itemx n
5289@kindex n (Summary)
5290@kindex G n (Summary)
5291@findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5292@c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5293Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5294
5295@item G p
5296@itemx p
5297@kindex p (Summary)
5298@findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5299@c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5300Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5301
5302@item G N
5303@itemx N
5304@kindex N (Summary)
5305@kindex G N (Summary)
5306@findex gnus-summary-next-article
5307Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5308
5309@item G P
5310@itemx P
5311@kindex P (Summary)
5312@kindex G P (Summary)
5313@findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5314Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5315
5316@item G C-n
5317@kindex G C-n (Summary)
5318@findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5319Go to the next article with the same subject
5320(@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5321
5322@item G C-p
5323@kindex G C-p (Summary)
5324@findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5325Go to the previous article with the same subject
5326(@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5327
5328@item G f
5329@itemx .
5330@kindex G f (Summary)
5331@kindex . (Summary)
5332@findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5333Go to the first unread article
5334(@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5335
5336@item G b
5337@itemx ,
5338@kindex G b (Summary)
5339@kindex , (Summary)
5340@findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5341Go to the unread article with the highest score
5342(@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5343go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5344
5345@item G l
5346@itemx l
5347@kindex l (Summary)
5348@kindex G l (Summary)
5349@findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5350Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5351
5352@item G o
5353@kindex G o (Summary)
5354@findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5355@cindex history
5356@cindex article history
5357Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5358(@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5359command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5360history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5361For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5362@pxref{Article Backlog}.
5363
5364@item G j
5365@itemx j
5366@kindex j (Summary)
5367@kindex G j (Summary)
5368@findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5369Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5370article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5371
5372@end table
5373
5374
5375@node Choosing Variables
5376@subsection Choosing Variables
5377
5378Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5379
5380@table @code
5381@item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5382@vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5383All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5384article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5385this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5386the server and display it in the article buffer.
5387
5388@item gnus-select-article-hook
5389@vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5390This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5391@code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5392you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5393hook will do so.
5394
5395@item gnus-mark-article-hook
5396@vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5397@findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5398@findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5399@findex gnus-unread-mark
5400This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5401be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5402@code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5403mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5404articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5405expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5406marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5407instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5408@code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5409
5410@end table
5411
5412
5413@node Paging the Article
5414@section Scrolling the Article
5415@cindex article scrolling
5416
5417@table @kbd
5418
5419@item SPACE
5420@kindex SPACE (Summary)
5421@findex gnus-summary-next-page
5422Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5423or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5424next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5425
5426@vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5427@vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5428If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5429the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5430skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5431what is considered uninteresting with
5432@code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5433pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5434
5435@item DEL
5436@kindex DEL (Summary)
5437@findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5438Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5439
5440@item RET
5441@kindex RET (Summary)
5442@findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5443Scroll the current article one line forward
5444(@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5445
5446@item M-RET
5447@kindex M-RET (Summary)
5448@findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5449Scroll the current article one line backward
5450(@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5451
5452@item A g
5453@itemx g
5454@kindex A g (Summary)
5455@kindex g (Summary)
5456@findex gnus-summary-show-article
5457@vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5458(Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5459given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
5460article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
5461the way it came from the server.
5462
5463If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5464@kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5465encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5466
5467@lisp
5468(setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5469 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5470 (2 . big5)))
5471@end lisp
5472
5473then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5474
5475@item A <
5476@itemx <
5477@kindex < (Summary)
5478@kindex A < (Summary)
5479@findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5480Scroll to the beginning of the article
5481(@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5482
5483@item A >
5484@itemx >
5485@kindex > (Summary)
5486@kindex A > (Summary)
5487@findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5488Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5489
5490@item A s
5491@itemx s
5492@kindex A s (Summary)
5493@kindex s (Summary)
5494@findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5495Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5496(@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5497
5498@item h
5499@kindex h (Summary)
5500@findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5501Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5502
5503@end table
5504
5505
5506@node Reply Followup and Post
5507@section Reply, Followup and Post
5508
5509@menu
5510* Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5511* Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5512* Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5513* Canceling and Superseding::
5514@end menu
5515
5516
5517@node Summary Mail Commands
5518@subsection Summary Mail Commands
5519@cindex mail
5520@cindex composing mail
5521
5522Commands for composing a mail message:
5523
5524@table @kbd
5525
5526@item S r
5527@itemx r
5528@kindex S r (Summary)
5529@kindex r (Summary)
5530@findex gnus-summary-reply
5531@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5532@c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5533Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5534(@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5535
5536@item S R
5537@itemx R
5538@kindex R (Summary)
5539@kindex S R (Summary)
5540@findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5541@c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5542Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5543original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5544command uses the process/prefix convention.
5545
5546@item S w
5547@kindex S w (Summary)
5548@findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5549Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5550(@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5551goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5552@code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5553present, that's used instead.
5554
5555@item S W
5556@kindex S W (Summary)
5557@findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5558Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5559message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5560the process/prefix convention.
5561
5562@item S v
5563@kindex S v (Summary)
5564@findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5565Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5566(@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5567that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5568@code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5569articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5570
5571@item S V
5572@kindex S V (Summary)
5573@findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5574Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5575original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5576command uses the process/prefix convention.
5577
5578@item S B r
5579@kindex S B r (Summary)
5580@findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5581Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5582@code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5583If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5584@code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5585the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5586correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5587
5588@item S B R
5589@kindex S B R (Summary)
5590@findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5591Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5592original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5593(@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5594
5595@item S o m
5596@itemx C-c C-f
5597@kindex S o m (Summary)
5598@kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5599@findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5600@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5601Forward the current article to some other person
5602(@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5603is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5604and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5605message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5606as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5607forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5608directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5609but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5610default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5611section.
5612
5613@item S m
5614@itemx m
5615@kindex m (Summary)
5616@kindex S m (Summary)
5617@findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5618@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5619Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5620the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5621If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5622
5623@item S i
5624@itemx i
5625@kindex i (Summary)
5626@kindex S i (Summary)
5627@findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5628Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5629post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5630prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5631
5632This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5633This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5634sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5635in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5636for this to work though.
5637
5638@item S D b
5639@kindex S D b (Summary)
5640@findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5641@cindex bouncing mail
5642If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5643reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5644resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5645will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5646sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5647the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5648that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5649very well fail, though.
5650
5651@item S D r
5652@kindex S D r (Summary)
5653@findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5654Not to be confused with the previous command,
5655@code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5656send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5657headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5658@code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5659means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5660header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5661So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5662
5663This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5664ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5665@code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5666to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5667@code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5668
5669This command understands the process/prefix convention
5670(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5671
5672@item S D e
5673@kindex S D e (Summary)
5674@findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5675
5676Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5677if it were a new message before resending.
5678
5679@item S O m
5680@kindex S O m (Summary)
5681@findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5682Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5683result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5684uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5685
5686@item S M-c
5687@kindex S M-c (Summary)
5688@findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5689@cindex crossposting
5690@cindex excessive crossposting
5691Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5692current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5693
5694@findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5695This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5696crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5697using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5698command understands the process/prefix convention
5699(@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5700
5701@end table
5702
5703Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5704Manual}, for more information.
5705
5706
5707@node Summary Post Commands
5708@subsection Summary Post Commands
5709@cindex post
5710@cindex composing news
5711
5712Commands for posting a news article:
5713
5714@table @kbd
5715@item S p
5716@itemx a
5717@kindex a (Summary)
5718@kindex S p (Summary)
5719@findex gnus-summary-post-news
5720@c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5721Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5722default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5723If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5724
5725@item S f
5726@itemx f
5727@kindex f (Summary)
5728@kindex S f (Summary)
5729@findex gnus-summary-followup
5730@c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5731Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5732
5733@item S F
5734@itemx F
5735@kindex S F (Summary)
5736@kindex F (Summary)
5737@c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5738@findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5739Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5740(@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5741process/prefix convention.
5742
5743@item S n
5744@kindex S n (Summary)
5745@findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5746Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5747message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5748
5749@item S N
5750@kindex S N (Summary)
5751@findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5752Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5753message through mail and include the original message
5754(@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5755the process/prefix convention.
5756
5757@item S o p
5758@kindex S o p (Summary)
5759@findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5760Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5761(@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5762 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5763of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5764(@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5765message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5766as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5767forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5768directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5769but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5770default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5771
5772@item S O p
5773@kindex S O p (Summary)
5774@findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5775@cindex digests
5776@cindex making digests
5777Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5778(@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5779process/prefix convention.
5780
5781@item S u
5782@kindex S u (Summary)
5783@findex gnus-uu-post-news
5784@c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5785Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5786(@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5787@end table
5788
5789Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5790Manual}, for more information.
5791
5792
5793@node Summary Message Commands
5794@subsection Summary Message Commands
5795
5796@table @kbd
5797@item S y
5798@kindex S y (Summary)
5799@findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5800Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5801buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5802what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5803process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5804
5805@end table
5806
5807
5808@node Canceling and Superseding
5809@subsection Canceling Articles
5810@cindex canceling articles
5811@cindex superseding articles
5812
5813Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5814really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5815
5816Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5817
5818@findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5819@kindex C (Summary)
5820@c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5821Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5822articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5823c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5824canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5825This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5826
5827Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5828live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5829question.
5830
5831Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5832want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5833prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5834
5835Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5836@code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5837message, Message Manual}).
5838
5839If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5840corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5841your original article.
5842
5843@findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5844@kindex S (Summary)
5845Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5846(@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5847where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5848usual way.
5849
5850The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5851sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5852have posted almost the same article twice.
5853
5854If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5855there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5856waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5857to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5858find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5859the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5860header by substituting one of those words for the word
5861@code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5862you would do normally. The previous article will be
5863canceled/superseded.
5864
5865Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5866
5867@node Delayed Articles
5868@section Delayed Articles
5869@cindex delayed sending
5870@cindex send delayed
5871
5872Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5873example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5874to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5875there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5876
5877@lisp
5878(gnus-delay-initialize)
5879@end lisp
5880
5881@findex gnus-delay-article
5882Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5883Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5884(@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5885message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5886
5887@itemize @bullet
5888@item
5889A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5890@code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5891(minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5892(months) and @code{Y} (years).
5893
5894@item
5895A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5896delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5897See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5898
5899@item
5900A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5901stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5902already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5903o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5904is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5905that means a time tomorrow.
5906@end itemize
5907
5908The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5909couple of variables:
5910
5911@table @code
5912@item gnus-delay-default-hour
5913@vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5914When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5915on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5916
5917@item gnus-delay-default-delay
5918@vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5919This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5920formats described above.
5921
5922@item gnus-delay-group
5923@vindex gnus-delay-group
5924Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5925they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5926value is @code{"delayed"}.
5927
5928@item gnus-delay-header
5929@vindex gnus-delay-header
5930The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5931is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5932change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5933@end table
5934
5935The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5936@code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5937calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5938@code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5939@code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5940
5941@findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5942And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5943which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5944function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5945@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5946Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5947execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5948
5949@table @code
5950@item gnus-delay-initialize
5951@findex gnus-delay-initialize
5952By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5953@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5954argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5955@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5956argument is ignored.
5957
5958For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5959Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5960Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5961@end table
5962
5963
5964@node Marking Articles
5965@section Marking Articles
5966@cindex article marking
5967@cindex article ticking
5968@cindex marks
5969
5970There are several marks you can set on an article.
5971
5972You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5973neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5974@dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5975
5976In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5977
5978@ifinfo
5979There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
5980@end ifinfo
5981
5982@menu
5983* Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
5984* Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
5985* Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
5986* Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
5987* Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
5988* Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
5989@end menu
5990
5991
5992@node Unread Articles
5993@subsection Unread Articles
5994
5995The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
5996other.
5997
5998@table @samp
5999@item !
6000@vindex gnus-ticked-mark
6001Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
6002
6003@dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
6004you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
6005reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
6006tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
6007news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
6008you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
6009(@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
6010
6011@item ?
6012@vindex gnus-dormant-mark
6013Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
6014
6015@dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
6016are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
6017followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
6018Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
6019messages.
6020
6021@item SPACE
6022@vindex gnus-unread-mark
6023Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
6024
6025@dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
6026@end table
6027
6028
6029@node Read Articles
6030@subsection Read Articles
6031@cindex expirable mark
6032
6033All the following marks mark articles as read.
6034
6035@table @samp
6036
6037@item r
6038@vindex gnus-del-mark
6039These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
6040command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
6041
6042@item R
6043@vindex gnus-read-mark
6044Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
6045
6046@item O
6047@vindex gnus-ancient-mark
6048Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
6049@dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
6050
6051@item K
6052@vindex gnus-killed-mark
6053Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
6054
6055@item X
6056@vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
6057Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
6058
6059@item Y
6060@vindex gnus-low-score-mark
6061Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
6062
6063@item C
6064@vindex gnus-catchup-mark
6065Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
6066
6067@item G
6068@vindex gnus-canceled-mark
6069Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
6070
6071@item F
6072@vindex gnus-souped-mark
6073@sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
6074
6075@item Q
6076@vindex gnus-sparse-mark
6077Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
6078Threading}.
6079
6080@item M
6081@vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
6082Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
6083(@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
6084
6085@end table
6086
6087All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
6088They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
6089
6090One more special mark, though:
6091
6092@table @samp
6093@item E
6094@vindex gnus-expirable-mark
6095Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
6096
6097Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
6098automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
6099control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
6100articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
6101any time.
6102@end table
6103
6104
6105@node Other Marks
6106@subsection Other Marks
6107@cindex process mark
6108@cindex bookmarks
6109
6110There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
6111read or not.
6112
6113@itemize @bullet
6114
6115@item
6116You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
6117long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
6118before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
6119in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
6120encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
6121
6122@item
6123@vindex gnus-replied-mark
6124All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
6125answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
6126(@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
6127
6128@item
6129@vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
6130All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
6131the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
6132
6133@item
6134@vindex gnus-cached-mark
6135Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
6136the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6137
6138@item
6139@vindex gnus-saved-mark
6140Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
6141religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
6142(@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
6143
6144@item
6145@vindex gnus-recent-mark
6146Articles that according to the server haven't been shown to the user
6147before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
6148(@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all servers support this
6149mark, in which case it simply never appears. Compare with
6150@code{gnus-unseen-mark}.
6151
6152@item
6153@vindex gnus-unseen-mark
6154Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
6155with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
6156Compare with @code{gnus-recent-mark}.
6157
6158@item
6159@vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
6160When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
6161downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
6162@samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
6163(The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
6164use.)
6165
6166@item
6167@vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
6168When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
6169not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
6170are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
6171articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
6172@code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
6173
6174@item
6175@vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
6176The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
6177automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
6178download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
6179explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
6180(The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
6181use.)
6182
6183@item
6184@vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
6185@vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
6186If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
6187marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
6188@code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
6189
6190@item
6191@vindex gnus-process-mark
6192Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
6193variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
6194instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
6195all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
6196marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
6197
6198@end itemize
6199
6200You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
6201appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
6202replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
6203
6204Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
6205replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
6206you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
6207
6208
6209@node Setting Marks
6210@subsection Setting Marks
6211@cindex setting marks
6212
6213All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
6214
6215@table @kbd
6216@item M c
6217@itemx M-u
6218@kindex M c (Summary)
6219@kindex M-u (Summary)
6220@findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
6221@cindex mark as unread
6222Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
6223(@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
6224article as unread.
6225
6226@item M t
6227@itemx !
6228@kindex ! (Summary)
6229@kindex M t (Summary)
6230@findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
6231Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
6232@xref{Article Caching}.
6233
6234@item M ?
6235@itemx ?
6236@kindex ? (Summary)
6237@kindex M ? (Summary)
6238@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
6239Mark the current article as dormant
6240(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6241
6242@item M d
6243@itemx d
6244@kindex M d (Summary)
6245@kindex d (Summary)
6246@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6247Mark the current article as read
6248(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
6249
6250@item D
6251@kindex D (Summary)
6252@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6253Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6254(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
6255
6256@item M k
6257@itemx k
6258@kindex k (Summary)
6259@kindex M k (Summary)
6260@findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6261Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6262and then select the next unread article
6263(@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
6264
6265@item M K
6266@itemx C-k
6267@kindex M K (Summary)
6268@kindex C-k (Summary)
6269@findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6270Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6271(@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
6272
6273@item M C
6274@kindex M C (Summary)
6275@findex gnus-summary-catchup
6276@c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6277Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
6278
6279@item M C-c
6280@kindex M C-c (Summary)
6281@findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6282Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6283articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6284
6285@item M H
6286@kindex M H (Summary)
6287@findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6288Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6289(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6290
6291@item M h
6292@kindex M h (Summary)
6293@findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6294Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6295(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6296
6297@item C-w
6298@kindex C-w (Summary)
6299@findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6300Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6301(@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6302
6303@item M V k
6304@kindex M V k (Summary)
6305@findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6306Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6307numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6308
6309@item M e
6310@itemx E
6311@kindex M e (Summary)
6312@kindex E (Summary)
6313@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6314Mark the current article as expirable
6315(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6316
6317@item M b
6318@kindex M b (Summary)
6319@findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6320Set a bookmark in the current article
6321(@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6322
6323@item M B
6324@kindex M B (Summary)
6325@findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6326Remove the bookmark from the current article
6327(@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6328
6329@item M V c
6330@kindex M V c (Summary)
6331@findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6332Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6333over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6334
6335@item M V u
6336@kindex M V u (Summary)
6337@findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6338Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6339numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6340
6341@item M V m
6342@kindex M V m (Summary)
6343@findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6344Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6345score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6346(@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6347@end table
6348
6349@vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6350The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6351be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6352the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6353one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6354@code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6355@kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6356The default is @code{t}.
6357
6358
6359@node Generic Marking Commands
6360@subsection Generic Marking Commands
6361
6362Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6363the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6364article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6365even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6366previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6367well.
6368
6369Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6370you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6371command should do.
6372
6373To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6374different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6375buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6376to list in this manual.
6377
6378While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6379altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6380@kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6381article, you could say something like:
6382
6383@lisp
6384@group
6385(add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6386(defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6387 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6388@end group
6389@end lisp
6390
6391@noindent
6392or
6393
6394@lisp
6395(defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6396 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6397@end lisp
6398
6399
6400@node Setting Process Marks
6401@subsection Setting Process Marks
6402@cindex setting process marks
6403
6404Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6405used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6406process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6407articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6408articles into the cache. For more information,
6409@pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6410
6411@table @kbd
6412
6413@item M P p
6414@itemx #
6415@kindex # (Summary)
6416@kindex M P p (Summary)
6417@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6418Mark the current article with the process mark
6419(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6420@findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6421
6422@item M P u
6423@itemx M-#
6424@kindex M P u (Summary)
6425@kindex M-# (Summary)
6426Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6427(@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6428
6429@item M P U
6430@kindex M P U (Summary)
6431@findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6432Remove the process mark from all articles
6433(@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6434
6435@item M P i
6436@kindex M P i (Summary)
6437@findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6438Invert the list of process marked articles
6439(@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6440
6441@item M P R
6442@kindex M P R (Summary)
6443@findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6444Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6445expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6446
6447@item M P G
6448@kindex M P G (Summary)
6449@findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6450Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6451expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6452
6453@item M P r
6454@kindex M P r (Summary)
6455@findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6456Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6457
6458@item M P g
6459@kindex M P g (Summary)
6460@findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6461Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6462
6463@item M P t
6464@kindex M P t (Summary)
6465@findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6466Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6467(@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6468
6469@item M P T
6470@kindex M P T (Summary)
6471@findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6472Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6473(@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6474
6475@item M P v
6476@kindex M P v (Summary)
6477@findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6478Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6479(@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6480
6481@item M P s
6482@kindex M P s (Summary)
6483@findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6484Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6485
6486@item M P S
6487@kindex M P S (Summary)
6488@findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6489Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6490(@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6491
6492@item M P a
6493@kindex M P a (Summary)
6494@findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6495Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6496
6497@item M P b
6498@kindex M P b (Summary)
6499@findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6500Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6501(@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6502
6503@item M P k
6504@kindex M P k (Summary)
6505@findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6506Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6507(@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6508
6509@item M P y
6510@kindex M P y (Summary)
6511@findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6512Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6513(@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6514
6515@item M P w
6516@kindex M P w (Summary)
6517@findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6518Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6519(@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6520
6521@end table
6522
6523Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6524set process marks based on article body contents.
6525
6526
6527@node Limiting
6528@section Limiting
6529@cindex limiting
6530
6531It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6532subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6533commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6534buffer.
6535
6536All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
6537from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
6538additional articles.
6539
6540@table @kbd
6541
6542@item / /
6543@itemx / s
6544@kindex / / (Summary)
6545@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6546Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6547(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6548matching articles.
6549
6550@item / a
6551@kindex / a (Summary)
6552@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6553Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6554(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6555matching articles.
6556
01c52d31
MB
6557@item / R
6558@kindex / R (Summary)
6559@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient
6560Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some recipient
6561(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient}). If given a prefix, exclude
6562matching articles.
6563
6564@item / A
6565@kindex / A (Summary)
6566@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-address
6567Limit the summary buffer to articles in which contents of From, To or Cc
6568header match a given address (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-address}). If
6569given a prefix, exclude matching articles.
6570
6571@item / S
6572@kindex / S (Summary)
6573@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons
6574Limit the summary buffer to articles that aren't part of any displayed
6575threads (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons}). If given a prefix,
6576limit to articles that are part of displayed threads.
6577
4009494e
GM
6578@item / x
6579@kindex / x (Summary)
6580@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6581Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6582headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6583(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6584matching articles.
6585
6586@item / u
6587@itemx x
6588@kindex / u (Summary)
6589@kindex x (Summary)
6590@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6591Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6592(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6593buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6594dormant articles will also be excluded.
6595
6596@item / m
6597@kindex / m (Summary)
6598@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6599Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6600with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6601
6602@item / t
6603@kindex / t (Summary)
6604@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6605Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6606(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6607articles younger than that number of days.
6608
6609@item / n
6610@kindex / n (Summary)
6611@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6612With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
6613articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
6614instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
6615
6616@item / w
6617@kindex / w (Summary)
6618@findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6619Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6620(@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6621the stack.
6622
6623@item / .
6624@kindex / . (Summary)
6625@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6626Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6627(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6628
6629@item / v
6630@kindex / v (Summary)
6631@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6632Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6633score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6634
6635@item / p
6636@kindex / p (Summary)
6637@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6638Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6639group parameter predicate
6640(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6641Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6642
01c52d31
MB
6643@item / r
6644@kindex / r (Summary)
6645@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-replied
6646Limit the summary buffer to replied articles
6647(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-replied}). If given a prefix, exclude
6648replied articles.
6649
4009494e
GM
6650@item / E
6651@itemx M S
6652@kindex M S (Summary)
6653@kindex / E (Summary)
6654@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6655Include all expunged articles in the limit
6656(@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6657
6658@item / D
6659@kindex / D (Summary)
6660@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6661Include all dormant articles in the limit
6662(@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6663
6664@item / *
6665@kindex / * (Summary)
6666@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6667Include all cached articles in the limit
6668(@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6669
6670@item / d
6671@kindex / d (Summary)
6672@findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6673Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6674(@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6675
6676@item / M
6677@kindex / M (Summary)
6678@findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6679Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6680
6681@item / T
6682@kindex / T (Summary)
6683@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6684Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6685
6686@item / c
6687@kindex / c (Summary)
6688@findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6689Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6690(@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6691
6692@item / C
6693@kindex / C (Summary)
6694@findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6695Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6696(@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6697also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6698
6699@item / N
6700@kindex / N (Summary)
6701@findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6702Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6703if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6704
6705@item / o
6706@kindex / o (Summary)
6707@findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6708Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6709prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6710
01c52d31
MB
6711@item / b
6712@kindex / b (Summary)
6713@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies
6714Limit the summary buffer to articles that have bodies that match a
6715certain regexp (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies}). If given a
6716prefix, reverse the limit. This command is quite slow since it
6717requires selecting each article to find the matches.
6718
6719@item / h
6720@kindex / h (Summary)
6721@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-headers
6722Like the previous command, only limit to headers instead
6723(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-headers}).
6724
4009494e
GM
6725@end table
6726
6727
6728@node Threading
6729@section Threading
6730@cindex threading
6731@cindex article threading
6732
6733Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6734to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6735hierarchical fashion.
6736
6737Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6738articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6739trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6740or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6741so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6742plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6743@ref{Customizing Threading}.
6744
6745First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6746
6747@table @dfn
6748@item root
6749The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6750
6751@item thread
6752A tree-like article structure.
6753
6754@item sub-thread
6755A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6756
6757@item loose threads
6758Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6759already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6760summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6761belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6762called loose threads.
6763
6764@item thread gathering
6765An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6766
6767@item sparse threads
6768A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6769displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6770
6771@end table
6772
6773
6774@menu
6775* Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6776* Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6777@end menu
6778
6779
6780@node Customizing Threading
6781@subsection Customizing Threading
6782@cindex customizing threading
6783
6784@menu
6785* Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6786* Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6787* More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6788* Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6789@end menu
6790
6791
6792@node Loose Threads
6793@subsubsection Loose Threads
6794@cindex <
6795@cindex >
6796@cindex loose threads
6797
6798@table @code
6799@item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6800@vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6801If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6802and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6803Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6804read or killed the root in a previous session.
6805
6806When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6807something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6808There are four possible values:
6809
6810@iftex
6811@iflatex
6812\gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6813\put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6814\put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6815\put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6816\put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6817}
6818@end iflatex
6819@end iftex
6820
6821@cindex adopting articles
6822
6823@table @code
6824
6825@item adopt
6826Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6827parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6828marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6829square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6830
6831@item dummy
6832@vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6833@vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6834Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6835parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6836selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6837article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6838format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6839which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6840If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6841ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6842
6843@item empty
6844Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6845subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6846use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6847Buffer Format}).)
6848
6849@item none
6850Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6851display them after one another.
6852
6853@item nil
6854Don't gather loose threads.
6855@end table
6856
6857@item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6858@vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6859Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6860variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6861subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6862super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6863presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6864you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6865first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6866variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6867everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6868
6869@cindex fuzzy article gathering
6870If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6871use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6872Matching}).
6873
6874@item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6875@vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6876This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6877that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6878simplification is used.
6879
6880@item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6881@vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6882If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6883as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6884
6885@c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6886@lisp
6887(setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6888 (concat
6889 "\\`\\[?\\("
6890 (mapconcat
6891 'identity
6892 '("looking"
6893 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6894 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6895 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6896 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6897 ;; ...
6898 )
6899 "\\|")
6900 "\\)\\s *\\("
6901 (mapconcat 'identity
6902 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6903 "\\|")
6904 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6905@end lisp
6906
6907All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6908subjects.
6909
6910@item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6911@vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6912If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6913@code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6914list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6915arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6916
6917Useful functions to put in this list include:
6918
6919@table @code
6920@item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6921@findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6922Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6923
6924@item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6925@findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6926Simplify fuzzily.
6927
6928@item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6929@findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6930Remove excessive whitespace.
6931
6932@item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6933@findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6934Remove all whitespace.
6935@end table
6936
6937You may also write your own functions, of course.
6938
6939
6940@item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6941@vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6942Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6943to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6944@samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6945you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6946what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6947The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6948
6949@item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6950@vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6951Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6952that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6953is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6954@code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6955This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6956articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6957newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6958cholera:
6959
6960@table @code
6961@item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6962@findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6963This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6964@code{Subject}s exclusively.
6965
6966@item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6967@findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6968This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6969@end table
6970
6971If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6972something like:
6973
6974@lisp
6975(setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6976 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6977@end lisp
6978
6979@end table
6980
6981
6982@node Filling In Threads
6983@subsubsection Filling In Threads
6984
6985@table @code
6986@item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6987@vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
6988If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
6989more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
6990like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
6991many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
6992@code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
6993number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
6994old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
6995files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
6996@code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
6997the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
6998do about that.
6999
7000This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
7001visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
7002(@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
7003
7004@item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7005@vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7006Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
7007newsgroups.
7008
7009@item gnus-build-sparse-threads
7010@vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
7011Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
7012gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
7013the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
7014together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
7015@dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
7016is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
7017lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
7018question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
7019``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
7020thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
7021off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
7022@code{nil} by default.
7023
7024@item gnus-read-all-available-headers
7025@vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
7026This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
7027intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
7028quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
7029go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
7030web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
7031
7032If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
7033@code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
7034that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
7035
7036@end table
7037
7038
7039@node More Threading
7040@subsubsection More Threading
7041
7042@table @code
7043@item gnus-show-threads
7044@vindex gnus-show-threads
7045If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
7046the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
7047off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
7048slower and more awkward.
7049
7050@item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7051@vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7052If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
7053generated.
7054
7055This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
7056Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
7057@code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
7058
7059Here's an example:
7060
7061@lisp
7062(setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7063 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
7064 gnus-article-unseen-p))
7065@end lisp
7066
7067(It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
7068unread, but you get my drift.)
7069
7070
7071@item gnus-thread-expunge-below
7072@vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
7073All threads that have a total score (as defined by
7074@code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
7075expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
7076threads are expunged.
7077
7078@item gnus-thread-hide-killed
7079@vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
7080if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
7081will be hidden.
7082
7083@item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7084@vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7085Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
7086this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
7087change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
7088result in a new thread.
7089
7090@item gnus-thread-indent-level
7091@vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
7092This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
7093The default is 4.
7094
7095@item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7096@vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7097Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
7098arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
7099arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
7100using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
7101up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
7102Setting this variable to an alternate value
7103(e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
7104appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
7105more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
7106
7107@end table
7108
7109
7110@node Low-Level Threading
7111@subsubsection Low-Level Threading
7112
7113@table @code
7114
7115@item gnus-parse-headers-hook
7116@vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
7117Hook run before parsing any headers.
7118
7119@item gnus-alter-header-function
7120@vindex gnus-alter-header-function
7121If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
7122article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
7123the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
7124if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
7125in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
7126variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
7127meaningful. Here's one example:
7128
7129@lisp
7130(setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
7131
7132(defun my-alter-message-id (header)
7133 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
7134 (when (string-match
7135 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
7136 (mail-header-set-id
7137 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
7138 header))))
7139@end lisp
7140
7141@end table
7142
7143
7144@node Thread Commands
7145@subsection Thread Commands
7146@cindex thread commands
7147
7148@table @kbd
7149
7150@item T k
7151@itemx C-M-k
7152@kindex T k (Summary)
7153@kindex C-M-k (Summary)
7154@findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
7155Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
7156(@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
7157remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
7158articles instead.
7159
7160@item T l
7161@itemx C-M-l
7162@kindex T l (Summary)
7163@kindex C-M-l (Summary)
7164@findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
7165Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
7166(@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
7167
7168@item T i
7169@kindex T i (Summary)
7170@findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
7171Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
7172(@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
7173
7174@item T #
7175@kindex T # (Summary)
7176@findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
7177Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
7178(@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7179
7180@item T M-#
7181@kindex T M-# (Summary)
7182@findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
7183Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
7184(@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7185
7186@item T T
7187@kindex T T (Summary)
7188@findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
7189Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
7190
7191@item T s
7192@kindex T s (Summary)
7193@findex gnus-summary-show-thread
7194Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
7195(@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
7196
7197@item T h
7198@kindex T h (Summary)
7199@findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
7200Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
7201
7202@item T S
7203@kindex T S (Summary)
7204@findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
7205Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
7206
7207@item T H
7208@kindex T H (Summary)
7209@findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
7210Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
7211
7212@item T t
7213@kindex T t (Summary)
7214@findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
7215Re-thread the current article's thread
7216(@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
7217summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
7218
7219@item T ^
7220@kindex T ^ (Summary)
7221@findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
7222Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
7223(@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
7224
01c52d31
MB
7225@item T M-^
7226@kindex T M-^ (Summary)
7227@findex gnus-summary-reparent-children
7228Make the current article the parent of the marked articles
7229(@code{gnus-summary-reparent-children}).
7230
4009494e
GM
7231@end table
7232
7233The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
7234understand the numeric prefix.
7235
7236@table @kbd
7237
7238@item T n
7239@kindex T n (Summary)
7240@itemx C-M-f
7241@kindex C-M-n (Summary)
7242@itemx M-down
7243@kindex M-down (Summary)
7244@findex gnus-summary-next-thread
7245Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
7246
7247@item T p
7248@kindex T p (Summary)
7249@itemx C-M-b
7250@kindex C-M-p (Summary)
7251@itemx M-up
7252@kindex M-up (Summary)
7253@findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
7254Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
7255
7256@item T d
7257@kindex T d (Summary)
7258@findex gnus-summary-down-thread
7259Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
7260
7261@item T u
7262@kindex T u (Summary)
7263@findex gnus-summary-up-thread
7264Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
7265
7266@item T o
7267@kindex T o (Summary)
7268@findex gnus-summary-top-thread
7269Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
7270@end table
7271
7272@vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
7273If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
7274threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
7275a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
7276wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
7277have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
7278you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
7279is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
7280when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
7281the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
7282operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
7283that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
7284Matching}).
7285
7286
7287@node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7288@section Sorting the Summary Buffer
7289
7290@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7291@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7292@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7293@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7294@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
01c52d31 7295@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient
4009494e
GM
7296@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7297@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7298@vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7299@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7300@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7301If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7302setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7303function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7304@code{(not some-function)} elements.
7305
7306By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7307predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
01c52d31
MB
7308@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient},
7309@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7310@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date},
7311@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
4009494e
GM
7312@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7313@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7314@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7315@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
7316
7317Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7318thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
7319normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
7320
7321If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7322last function in the list. You should probably always include
7323@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7324functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7325equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7326ascending article order.
7327
7328If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7329by number, you could do something like:
7330
7331@lisp
7332(setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7333 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7334 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7335 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7336@end lisp
7337
7338The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7339summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7340alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7341subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7342which the articles arrived.
7343
7344If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7345say something like:
7346
7347@lisp
7348(setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
01c52d31 7349 '((not gnus-thread-sort-by-number)
4009494e
GM
7350 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7351@end lisp
7352
7353@vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7354The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7355@code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7356functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7357tickles your fancy.
7358
7359@findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7360@findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7361@findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7362@findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7363@findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7364@findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7365@findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7366If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7367other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7368variable. It is very similar to the
7369@code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7370different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7371predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7372@code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7373@code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7374@code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7375@code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7376
7377If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7378say something like:
7379
7380@lisp
7381(setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7382 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7383 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7384@end lisp
7385
01c52d31
MB
7386You can define group specific sorting via @code{gnus-parameters},
7387@xref{Group Parameters}.
4009494e
GM
7388
7389
7390@node Asynchronous Fetching
7391@section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7392@cindex asynchronous article fetching
7393@cindex article pre-fetch
7394@cindex pre-fetch
7395
7396If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7397network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7398for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7399article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7400while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7401
7402First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7403article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7404
7405Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7406quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7407know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7408article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7409connection is blocked.
7410
7411To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7412connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7413thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7414extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7415
7416Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7417the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7418loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7419also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7420extra connection.
7421
7422Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7423you really want to.
7424
7425@vindex gnus-asynchronous
7426Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7427happen automatically.
7428
7429@vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7430You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7431@code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7432that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7433the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7434pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7435@code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7436
7437@vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7438@findex gnus-async-unread-p
7439There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7440articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7441variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7442function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7443to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
7444returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7445article data structure as the only parameter.
7446
7447If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7448than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7449
7450@lisp
7451(defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7452 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7453 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7454 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7455 100)))
7456
7457(setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7458@end lisp
7459
7460These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7461preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7462It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7463
7464@vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7465Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7466@code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7467articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7468
7469@table @code
7470@item read
7471Remove articles when they are read.
7472
7473@item exit
7474Remove articles when exiting the group.
7475@end table
7476
7477The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7478
7479@c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7480@c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7481@c from the next group.
7482
7483
7484@node Article Caching
7485@section Article Caching
7486@cindex article caching
7487@cindex caching
7488
7489If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7490consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7491locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7492potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7493your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7494
7495Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7496
7497@vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7498@vindex gnus-cache-directory
7499@vindex gnus-use-cache
7500To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7501all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7502over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7503cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7504@code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7505
7506When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7507cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7508expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7509keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7510as dormant, and don't worry.
7511
7512When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7513
7514@vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7515@vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7516The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7517@code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7518variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7519dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7520put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7521articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7522symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7523@code{unread} and @code{read}.
7524
7525@findex gnus-jog-cache
7526So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7527picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7528subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7529store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7530command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7531really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7532Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7533to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7534not then be downloaded by this command.
7535
7536@vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7537@vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7538It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7539if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7540sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7541feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7542
7543To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7544regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7545@code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7546Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7547variables, the group is not cached.
7548
7549@findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7550@findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7551@vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7552The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7553file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7554of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7555offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7556gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7557files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7558file.
7559
7560@findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7561@code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7562@code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7563where, isn't that cool?
7564
7565@node Persistent Articles
7566@section Persistent Articles
7567@cindex persistent articles
7568
7569Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7570In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7571useful in my opinion.
7572
7573Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7574that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7575(using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7576that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7577the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7578the expiry going on at the news server.
7579
7580This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7581be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7582you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7583
7584@table @kbd
7585
7586@item *
7587@kindex * (Summary)
7588@findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7589Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7590
7591@item M-*
7592@kindex M-* (Summary)
7593@findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7594Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7595(@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7596article.
7597@end table
7598
7599Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7600
7601To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7602you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7603interested in persistent articles:
7604
7605@lisp
7606(setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7607@end lisp
7608
01c52d31
MB
7609@node Sticky Articles
7610@section Sticky Articles
7611@cindex sticky articles
7612
7613When you select an article the current article buffer will be reused
7614according to the value of the variable
7615@code{gnus-single-article-buffer}. If its value is non-@code{nil} (the
7616default) all articles reuse the same article buffer. Else each group
7617has its own article buffer.
7618
7619This implies that it's not possible to have more than one article buffer
7620in a group at a time. But sometimes you might want to display all the
7621latest emails from your mother, your father, your aunt, your uncle and
7622your 17 cousins to coordinate the next christmas party.
7623
7624That's where sticky articles come in handy. A sticky article buffer
7625basically is a normal article buffer, but it won't be reused when you
7626select another article. You can make an article sticky with:
7627
7628@table @kbd
7629@item A S
7630@kindex A S (Summary)
7631@findex gnus-sticky-article
7632Make the current article sticky. If a prefix arg is given, ask for a
7633name for this sticky article buffer.
7634@end table
7635
7636To close a sticky article buffer you can use these commands:
7637
7638@table @kbd
7639@item q
7640@kindex q (Article)
7641@findex bury-buffer
7642Puts this sticky article buffer at the end of the list of all buffers.
7643
7644@item k
7645@kindex k (Article)
7646@findex gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffer
7647Kills this sticky article buffer.
7648@end table
7649
7650To kill all sticky article buffers you can use:
7651
7652@defun gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffers ARG
7653Kill all sticky article buffers.
7654If a prefix ARG is given, ask for confirmation.
7655@end defun
4009494e
GM
7656
7657@node Article Backlog
7658@section Article Backlog
7659@cindex backlog
7660@cindex article backlog
7661
7662If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7663unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7664by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7665already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7666you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7667re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7668that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7669increase memory usage some.
7670
7671@vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7672If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7673at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7674variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7675@emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7676bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7677that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7678
7679The default value is 20.
7680
7681
7682@node Saving Articles
7683@section Saving Articles
7684@cindex saving articles
7685
7686Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7687for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7688processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7689approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7690(@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7691
7692For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7693save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7694command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7695
7696@vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7697If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7698unwanted headers before saving the article.
7699
7700@vindex gnus-saved-headers
7701If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7702@code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7703deleted before saving.
7704
7705@table @kbd
7706
7707@item O o
7708@itemx o
7709@kindex O o (Summary)
7710@kindex o (Summary)
7711@findex gnus-summary-save-article
7712@c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7713Save the current article using the default article saver
7714(@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7715
7716@item O m
7717@kindex O m (Summary)
7718@findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7719Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7720(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7721
7722@item O r
7723@kindex O r (Summary)
7724@findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7725Save the current article in Rmail format
7726(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
7727
7728@item O f
7729@kindex O f (Summary)
7730@findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7731@c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7732Save the current article in plain file format
7733(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7734
7735@item O F
7736@kindex O F (Summary)
7737@findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7738Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7739file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7740
7741@item O b
7742@kindex O b (Summary)
7743@findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7744Save the current article body in plain file format
7745(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7746
7747@item O h
7748@kindex O h (Summary)
7749@findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7750Save the current article in mh folder format
7751(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7752
7753@item O v
7754@kindex O v (Summary)
7755@findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7756Save the current article in a VM folder
7757(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7758
7759@item O p
7760@itemx |
7761@kindex O p (Summary)
7762@kindex | (Summary)
7763@findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7764Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7765the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7766If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7767complete headers in the piped output.
7768
7769@item O P
7770@kindex O P (Summary)
7771@findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7772@vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7773Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7774external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7775Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7776variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7777(@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7778
7779@end table
7780
7781@vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7782All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7783(@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7784functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7785and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7786the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7787default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7788loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7789just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7790have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7791to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7792save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7793files.
7794
7795
7796@vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7797You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7798Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7799functions below, or you can create your own.
7800
7801@table @code
7802
7803@item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7804@findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7805@vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7806@findex gnus-plain-save-name
7807This is the default format, @dfn{Babyl}. Uses the function in the
7808@code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7809article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7810
7811@item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7812@findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7813@vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7814Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7815@code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7816article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7817
7818@item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7819@findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7820@vindex gnus-file-save-name
7821@findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7822Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7823the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7824article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7825
7826@item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7827@findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7828Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7829overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7830@code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7831article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7832
7833@item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7834@findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7835Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7836@code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7837article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7838
7839@item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7840@findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7841Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7842overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7843@code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7844article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7845
7846@item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7847@findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7848@findex gnus-folder-save-name
7849@findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7850@vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7851@cindex rcvstore
7852@cindex MH folders
7853Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7854library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7855to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7856@code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7857@code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7858
7859@item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7860@findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7861Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7862reader to use this setting.
7863@end table
7864
7865The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
7866
7867@table @code
7868@item :decode
7869The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7870meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7871@code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7872@code{gnus-summary-write-to-file}, and
7873@code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7874
7875@item :function
7876The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7877overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7878articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7879@code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7880meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7881@code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7882
7883@item :headers
7884The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7885specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7886@code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7887headers should be saved.
7888@end table
7889
7890@vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7891All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7892in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7893@env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7894default.
7895
7896As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7897suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7898available functions that generate names:
7899
7900@table @code
7901
7902@item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7903@findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7904File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7905
7906@item gnus-numeric-save-name
7907@findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7908File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7909
7910@item gnus-Plain-save-name
7911@findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7912File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7913
7914@item gnus-plain-save-name
7915@findex gnus-plain-save-name
7916File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7917
7918@item gnus-sender-save-name
7919@findex gnus-sender-save-name
7920File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7921@end table
7922
7923@vindex gnus-split-methods
7924You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7925the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7926save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7927related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7928like:
7929
7930@lisp
7931(("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7932 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7933 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7934 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
7935@end lisp
7936
7937We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
7938elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
7939a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
7940head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
7941group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
7942@code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
7943the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
7944result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
7945called returns a string or a list of strings.
7946
7947You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
7948saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
7949then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
7950name completion over the results from applying this variable.
7951
7952This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
7953means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
7954@code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
7955name.
7956
7957Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
7958lots of mail groups called things like
7959@samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
7960these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
7961following will do just that:
7962
7963@lisp
7964(defun my-save-name (group)
7965 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
7966 (substring group (match-end 0))))
7967
7968(setq gnus-split-methods
7969 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
7970 (my-save-name)))
7971@end lisp
7972
7973
7974@vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7975Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
7976@code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
7977(@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
7978the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
7979all the files in the top level directory
7980(@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
7981@file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
7982on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
7983Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
7984
7985This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
7986is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
7987names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
7988@code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
7989contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
7990for kill files.
7991
7992If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
7993a spool, you could
7994
7995@lisp
7996(setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
7997(setq gnus-default-article-saver
7998 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
7999@end lisp
8000
8001Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
8002ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
8003the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
8004around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
8005
8006
8007@node Decoding Articles
8008@section Decoding Articles
8009@cindex decoding articles
8010
8011Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
8012encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
8013
8014@menu
8015* Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
8016* Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
8017* PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
8018* Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
8019* Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
8020* Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
8021@end menu
8022
8023@cindex series
8024@cindex article series
8025All these functions use the process/prefix convention
8026(@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
8027the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
8028can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
8029articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
8030
8031Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
8032simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
8033last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
8034
8035For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
8036will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
8037([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
8038
8039Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
8040series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
8041commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
8042
8043
8044@node Uuencoded Articles
8045@subsection Uuencoded Articles
8046@cindex uudecode
8047@cindex uuencoded articles
8048
8049@table @kbd
8050
8051@item X u
8052@kindex X u (Summary)
8053@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
8054@c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
8055Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
8056
8057@item X U
8058@kindex X U (Summary)
8059@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
8060Uudecodes and saves the current series
8061(@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8062
8063@item X v u
8064@kindex X v u (Summary)
8065@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
8066Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
8067
8068@item X v U
8069@kindex X v U (Summary)
8070@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
8071Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
8072(@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
8073
8074@end table
8075
8076Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
8077the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
8078entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
8079(@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
8080(@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8081
8082All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
8083@sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
8084the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
8085articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
8086@kbd{X u}.
8087
8088@vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
8089Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
8090@code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
8091@samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
8092automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
8093you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
8094off.
8095
8096
8097@node Shell Archives
8098@subsection Shell Archives
8099@cindex unshar
8100@cindex shell archives
8101@cindex shared articles
8102
8103Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
8104sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
8105some commands to deal with these:
8106
8107@table @kbd
8108
8109@item X s
8110@kindex X s (Summary)
8111@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
8112Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
8113
8114@item X S
8115@kindex X S (Summary)
8116@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
8117Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
8118
8119@item X v s
8120@kindex X v s (Summary)
8121@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
8122Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
8123
8124@item X v S
8125@kindex X v S (Summary)
8126@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
8127Unshars, views and saves the current series
8128(@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
8129@end table
8130
8131
8132@node PostScript Files
8133@subsection PostScript Files
8134@cindex PostScript
8135
8136@table @kbd
8137
8138@item X p
8139@kindex X p (Summary)
8140@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
8141Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
8142
8143@item X P
8144@kindex X P (Summary)
8145@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
8146Unpack and save the current PostScript series
8147(@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
8148
8149@item X v p
8150@kindex X v p (Summary)
8151@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
8152View the current PostScript series
8153(@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
8154
8155@item X v P
8156@kindex X v P (Summary)
8157@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
8158View and save the current PostScript series
8159(@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
8160@end table
8161
8162
8163@node Other Files
8164@subsection Other Files
8165
8166@table @kbd
8167@item X o
8168@kindex X o (Summary)
8169@findex gnus-uu-decode-save
8170Save the current series
8171(@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
8172
8173@item X b
8174@kindex X b (Summary)
8175@findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
8176Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
8177doesn't really work yet.
b890d447
MB
8178
8179@item X Y
8180@kindex X Y (Summary)
8181@findex gnus-uu-decode-yenc
8182yEnc-decode the current series and save it (@code{gnus-uu-decode-yenc}).
4009494e
GM
8183@end table
8184
8185
8186@node Decoding Variables
8187@subsection Decoding Variables
8188
8189Adjective, not verb.
8190
8191@menu
8192* Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
8193* Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
8194* Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
8195@end menu
8196
8197
8198@node Rule Variables
8199@subsubsection Rule Variables
8200@cindex rule variables
8201
8202Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
8203variables are of the form
8204
8205@lisp
8206 (list '(regexp1 command2)
8207 '(regexp2 command2)
8208 ...)
8209@end lisp
8210
8211@table @code
8212
8213@item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8214@vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8215@cindex sox
8216This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
8217for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
8218say something like:
8219@lisp
8220(setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8221 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
8222@end lisp
8223
8224@item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8225@vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8226This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
8227user and default view rules.
8228
8229@item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8230@vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8231This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
8232archives.
8233@end table
8234
8235
8236@node Other Decode Variables
8237@subsubsection Other Decode Variables
8238
8239@table @code
8240@vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8241
8242@item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8243All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
8244successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
8245and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
8246anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
8247
8248@table @code
8249
8250@item gnus-uu-grab-view
8251@findex gnus-uu-grab-view
8252View the file.
8253
8254@item gnus-uu-grab-move
8255@findex gnus-uu-grab-move
8256Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
8257@end table
8258
8259@item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8260@vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8261Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
8262@code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
8263that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
8264time.
8265
8266@item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8267@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8268Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
8269
8270@item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8271@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8272Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
8273Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
8274@code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
8275kludgey.
8276
8277@item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8278@vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8279Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
8280
8281@item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8282@vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8283Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
8284looking for files to display.
8285
8286@item gnus-uu-view-and-save
8287@vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
8288Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
8289after viewing it.
8290
8291@item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8292@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8293Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
8294rules.
8295
8296@item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8297@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8298Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
8299unpacking commands.
8300
8301@item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8302@vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8303Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
8304from articles.
8305
8306@item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8307@vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8308Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
8309decoded articles as unread.
8310
8311@item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8312@vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8313Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
8314uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
8315
8316@item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8317@vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8318Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
8319
8320@item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8321@vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8322@cindex metamail
8323Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
8324commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
8325content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
8326@code{metamail} for viewing.
8327
8328@item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8329@vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8330Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
8331decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
8332@code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
8333embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
8334to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
8335simply dropped them.
8336
8337@end table
8338
8339
8340@node Uuencoding and Posting
8341@subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
8342
8343@table @code
8344
8345@item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8346@vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8347Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8348before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8349either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8350for you when you post the article.
8351
8352@item gnus-uu-post-length
8353@vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8354Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8355many articles it takes to post the entire file.
8356
8357@item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8358@vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8359Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8360thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8361to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8362seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8363think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
8364
8365@item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8366@vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8367Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8368article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8369variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8370at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8371Default is @code{t}.
8372
8373@end table
8374
8375
8376@node Viewing Files
8377@subsection Viewing Files
8378@cindex viewing files
8379@cindex pseudo-articles
8380
8381After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8382to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8383viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8384containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8385uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8386This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8387of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
8388
8389Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8390extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8391``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8392will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
8393
8394@vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8395If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8396until the viewing is done before proceeding.
8397
8398@vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8399If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8400the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8401immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8402be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
8403
8404@vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8405If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8406pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8407@code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8408a list of parameters to that command.
8409
8410@vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8411If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8412pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
8413
8414So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8415@emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8416Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8417
8418
8419@node Article Treatment
8420@section Article Treatment
8421
8422Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8423object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8424written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8425writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8426these articles easier.
8427
8428@menu
8429* Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8430* Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8431* Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8432* Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8433* Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8434* Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8435* Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8436* Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8437* Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
8438* Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8439* Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8440@end menu
8441
8442
8443@node Article Highlighting
8444@subsection Article Highlighting
8445@cindex highlighting
8446
8447Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8448you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8449
8450@table @kbd
8451
8452@item W H a
8453@kindex W H a (Summary)
8454@findex gnus-article-highlight
8455@findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8456Do much highlighting of the current article
8457(@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8458text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8459
8460@item W H h
8461@kindex W H h (Summary)
8462@findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8463@vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8464Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8465highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8466variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8467@code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8468@var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8469header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8470(@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8471the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8472@var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8473
8474@item W H c
8475@kindex W H c (Summary)
8476@findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8477Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8478
8479Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8480
8481@table @code
8482@vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8483
8484@item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8485If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
848625000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8487
8488@item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8489@vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8490Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8491
8492@item gnus-cite-face-list
8493@vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8494List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8495When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8496Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8497This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8498
8499@item gnus-supercite-regexp
8500@vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8501Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8502
8503@item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8504@vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8505Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8506
8507@item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8508@vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8509Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8510that it's a citation.
8511
8512@item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8513@vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8514Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8515
8516@item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8517@vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8518Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8519
8520@item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8521@vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8522Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8523cited text belonging to the attribution.
8524
8525@item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8526@vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8527If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8528beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8529in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8530is @code{t}.
8531
8532@end table
8533
8534
8535@item W H s
8536@kindex W H s (Summary)
8537@vindex gnus-signature-separator
8538@vindex gnus-signature-face
8539@findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8540Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8541Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8542Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8543highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8544default.
8545
8546@end table
8547
8548@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8549
8550
8551@node Article Fontisizing
8552@subsection Article Fontisizing
8553@cindex emphasis
8554@cindex article emphasis
8555
8556@findex gnus-article-emphasize
8557@kindex W e (Summary)
8558People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8559like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8560this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8561(@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8562
8563@vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8564How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8565@code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8566element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8567that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8568emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8569should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8570groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8571highlighting.
8572
8573@lisp
8574(setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8575 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8576 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8577@end lisp
8578
8579@cindex slash
8580@cindex asterisk
8581@cindex underline
8582@cindex /
8583@cindex *
8584
8585@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8586@vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8587@vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8588@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8589@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8590@vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8591@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8592By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8593@code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8594@code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8595@code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8596@code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8597@code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8598
8599If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8600customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8601to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8602say something like:
8603
8604@lisp
8605(copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8606@end lisp
8607
8608@vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8609
8610If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8611@code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8612syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8613parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8614
8615@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8616
8617
8618@node Article Hiding
8619@subsection Article Hiding
8620@cindex article hiding
8621
8622Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8623too much cruft in most articles.
8624
8625@table @kbd
8626
8627@item W W a
8628@kindex W W a (Summary)
8629@findex gnus-article-hide
8630Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8631(@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8632headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8633
8634@item W W h
8635@kindex W W h (Summary)
8636@findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8637Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8638Headers}.
8639
8640@item W W b
8641@kindex W W b (Summary)
8642@findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8643Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8644(@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8645
8646@item W W s
8647@kindex W W s (Summary)
8648@findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8649Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8650Signature}.
8651
8652@item W W l
8653@kindex W W l (Summary)
8654@findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8655@vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8656Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8657are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8658@code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8659@samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8660may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8661
8662@table @code
8663
8664@item gnus-list-identifiers
8665@vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8666A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8667subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8668
8669@end table
8670
8671@item W W P
8672@kindex W W P (Summary)
8673@findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8674Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8675(@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8676
8677@item W W B
8678@kindex W W B (Summary)
8679@findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8680@vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8681@vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8682@cindex banner
8683@cindex OneList
8684@cindex stripping advertisements
8685@cindex advertisements
8686Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8687(@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8688annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8689groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8690the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8691group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8692which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8693removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8694signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8695corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8696used.
8697
8698Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8699the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8700@code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8701
8702@table @code
8703
8704@item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8705@vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8706Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8707@code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8708matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8709symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8710a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8711address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8712sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8713banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8714sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8715
8716@lisp
8717("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8718 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8719@end lisp
8720
8721@end table
8722
8723@item W W c
8724@kindex W W c (Summary)
8725@findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8726Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8727customizing the hiding:
8728
8729@table @code
8730
8731@item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8732@itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8733@vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8734@vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8735Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8736allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8737by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8738specs are valid:
8739
8740@table @samp
8741@item b
8742Starting point of the hidden text.
8743@item e
8744Ending point of the hidden text.
8745@item l
8746Number of characters in the hidden region.
8747@item n
8748Number of lines of hidden text.
8749@end table
8750
8751@item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8752@vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8753The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8754shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8755and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8756
8757@end table
8758
8759@item W W C-c
8760@kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8761@findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8762
8763Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8764following two variables:
8765
8766@table @code
8767@item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8768@vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8769If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
877050), hide the cited text.
8771
8772@item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8773@vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8774The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8775is hidden.
8776@end table
8777
8778@item W W C
8779@kindex W W C (Summary)
8780@findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8781Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8782(@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8783useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8784have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8785
8786@end table
8787
8788All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8789prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8790hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8791
8792Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8793citation customization.
8794
8795@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8796automatically.
8797
8798
8799@node Article Washing
8800@subsection Article Washing
8801@cindex washing
8802@cindex article washing
8803
8804We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8805@kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8806
8807@dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8808something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8809Cleaner, perhaps.
8810
8811@xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8812articles by default.
8813
8814@table @kbd
8815
8816@item C-u g
8817This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8818you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8819the server.
8820
8821@item g
8822Force redisplaying of the current article
8823(@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8824If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8825interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8826(@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8827
8828@item W l
8829@kindex W l (Summary)
8830@findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8831Remove page breaks from the current article
8832(@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8833delimiters.
8834
8835@item W r
8836@kindex W r (Summary)
8837@findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8838@c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8839Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8840(@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8841Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8842(Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8843
8844It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8845positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8846#15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8847is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8848
8849@item W m
8850@kindex W m (Summary)
8851@findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8852Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8853
01c52d31
MB
8854@item W i
8855@kindex W i (Summary)
8856@findex gnus-summary-idna-message
8857Decode IDNA encoded domain names in the current articles. IDNA
8858encoded domain names looks like @samp{xn--bar}. If a string remain
8859unencoded after running invoking this, it is likely an invalid IDNA
8860string (@samp{xn--bar} is invalid). You must have GNU Libidn
8861(@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/}) installed for this command
8862to work.
8863
4009494e
GM
8864@item W t
8865@item t
8866@kindex W t (Summary)
8867@kindex t (Summary)
8868@findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8869Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8870(@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8871
8872@item W v
8873@kindex W v (Summary)
8874@findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8875Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8876(@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8877
8878@item W o
8879@kindex W o (Summary)
8880@findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8881Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8882
8883@item W d
8884@kindex W d (Summary)
8885@findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8886@vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8887@cindex Smartquotes
8888@cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8889@cindex Latin 1
8890Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8891@code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8892(@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8893whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8894interactively.
8895
8896Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8897an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8898like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8899apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8900
8901@item W Y f
8902@kindex W Y f (Summary)
8903@findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8904@cindex Outlook Express
8905Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8906unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8907(@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8908
8909@item W Y u
8910@kindex W Y u (Summary)
8911@findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
8912@vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
8913@vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
8914Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
8915what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
8916@code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
8917@code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
8918maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
8919(@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
8920
8921@item W Y a
8922@kindex W Y a (Summary)
8923@findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
8924Repair a broken attribution line.@*
8925(@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
8926
8927@item W Y c
8928@kindex W Y c (Summary)
8929@findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
8930Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
8931(@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
8932
8933@item W w
8934@kindex W w (Summary)
8935@findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
8936Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
8937
8938You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
8939when filling.
8940
8941@item W Q
8942@kindex W Q (Summary)
8943@findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
8944Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
8945
8946@item W C
8947@kindex W C (Summary)
8948@findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
8949Capitalize the first word in each sentence
8950(@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
8951
8952@item W c
8953@kindex W c (Summary)
8954@findex gnus-article-remove-cr
8955Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
8956(this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
8957CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
8958(@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
8959
8960@item W q
8961@kindex W q (Summary)
8962@findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
8963Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
8964Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
8965sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
01c52d31
MB
8966makes strings like @samp{d@'ej@`a vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu},
8967which doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually
8968done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
4009494e
GM
8969@code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8970has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8971
8972@item W 6
8973@kindex W 6 (Summary)
8974@findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
8975Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
8976one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
8977non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
8978usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8979@code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8980has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8981
8982@item W Z
8983@kindex W Z (Summary)
8984@findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
8985Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
8986common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
8987makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
8988
01c52d31
MB
8989@item W A
8990@kindex W A (Summary)
8991@findex gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences
8992@cindex @acronym{ANSI} control sequences
8993Translate @acronym{ANSI} SGR control sequences into overlays or
8994extents (@code{gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences}). @acronym{ANSI}
8995sequences are used in some Chinese hierarchies for highlighting.
8996
4009494e
GM
8997@item W u
8998@kindex W u (Summary)
8999@findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
9000Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
9001outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
9002split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
9003the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
9004
9005@item W h
9006@kindex W h (Summary)
9007@findex gnus-article-wash-html
9008Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
9009usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9010@code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
9011
9012If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
9013the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
9014(@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
9015
9016@vindex gnus-article-wash-function
9017The default is to use the function specified by
9018@code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
9019Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
9020@acronym{HTML}, but this is controlled by the
9021@code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
9022can use include:
9023
9024@table @code
9025@item w3
9026Use Emacs/W3.
9027
9028@item w3m
9029Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
9030
9031@item w3m-standalone
9032Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
9033
9034@item links
9035Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
9036
9037@item lynx
9038Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
9039
9040@item html2text
9041Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
9042
9043@end table
9044
9045@item W b
9046@kindex W b (Summary)
9047@findex gnus-article-add-buttons
9048Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
9049@xref{Article Buttons}.
9050
9051@item W B
9052@kindex W B (Summary)
9053@findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
9054Add clickable buttons to the article headers
9055(@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
9056
9057@item W p
9058@kindex W p (Summary)
9059@findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
9060Verify a signed control message
9061(@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
9062@code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
9063hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
9064the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
9065message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
9066available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
9067
9068@item W s
9069@kindex W s (Summary)
9070@findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
9071Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
9072@acronym{S/MIME}) message
9073(@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
9074
9075@item W a
9076@kindex W a (Summary)
9077@findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
9078Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
9079article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
9080
9081@item W E l
9082@kindex W E l (Summary)
9083@findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
9084Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
9085(@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
9086
9087@item W E m
9088@kindex W E m (Summary)
9089@findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
9090Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
9091lines with a single empty line.
9092(@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
9093
9094@item W E t
9095@kindex W E t (Summary)
9096@findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
9097Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
9098(@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
9099
9100@item W E a
9101@kindex W E a (Summary)
9102@findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
9103Do all the three commands above
9104(@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
9105
9106@item W E A
9107@kindex W E A (Summary)
9108@findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
9109Remove all blank lines
9110(@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
9111
9112@item W E s
9113@kindex W E s (Summary)
9114@findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
9115Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
9116body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
9117
9118@item W E e
9119@kindex W E e (Summary)
9120@findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
9121Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
9122body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
9123
9124@end table
9125
9126@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
9127
9128
9129@node Article Header
9130@subsection Article Header
9131
9132These commands perform various transformations of article header.
9133
9134@table @kbd
9135
9136@item W G u
9137@kindex W G u (Summary)
9138@findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
9139Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
9140
9141@item W G n
9142@kindex W G n (Summary)
9143@findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
9144Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
9145(@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
9146
9147@item W G f
9148@kindex W G f (Summary)
9149@findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
9150Fold all the message headers
9151(@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
9152
9153@item W E w
9154@kindex W E w (Summary)
9155@findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
9156Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
9157(@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
9158
9159@end table
9160
9161
9162@node Article Buttons
9163@subsection Article Buttons
9164@cindex buttons
9165
9166People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
9167be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
9168with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
9169button on these references.
9170
9171@vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9172Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
9173Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
9174Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
9175one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
9176
9177@table @code
9178
9179@item gnus-button-alist
9180@vindex gnus-button-alist
9181This is an alist where each entry has this form:
9182
9183@lisp
9184(@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9185@end lisp
9186
9187@table @var
9188
9189@item regexp
9190All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
9191considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
9192embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
9193variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
9194@code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
9195
9196@item button-par
9197Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
9198is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
9199highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
9200
9201@item use-p
9202This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
9203this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
9204avoid false matches. Often variables named
9205@code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
9206Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
9207
9208@c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
9209
9210@item function
9211This function will be called when you click on this button.
9212
9213@item data-par
9214As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
9215says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
9216
9217@end table
9218
9219So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
9220
9221@lisp
9222("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
9223@end lisp
9224
9225@item gnus-header-button-alist
9226@vindex gnus-header-button-alist
9227This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
9228article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
9229used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
9230
9231@lisp
9232(@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9233@end lisp
9234
9235@var{header} is a regular expression.
9236@end table
9237
9238@subsubsection Related variables and functions
9239
9240@table @code
9241@item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
9242@xref{Article Button Levels}.
9243
9244@c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
9245
9246@item gnus-button-url-regexp
9247@vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
9248A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
9249default values of the variables above.
9250
9251@c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
9252
9253@item gnus-button-man-handler
9254@vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9255The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
9256argument with a string naming the man page.
9257
9258@c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
9259
9260@item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9261@vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9262Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
9263
9264@item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9265@vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9266This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
9267@samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
9268message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
9269@code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
9270a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
9271@code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
9272function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
9273function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
9274@code{ask}. The default value is the function
9275@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9276
9277@item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9278@findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9279Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
9280address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
9281it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
9282string is invalid.
9283
9284@item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9285@vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9286An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
9287@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9288
9289@c Stuff related to gnus-button-tex-level
9290
9291@item gnus-button-ctan-handler
9292@findex gnus-button-ctan-handler
9293The function to use for displaying CTAN links. It must take one
9294argument, the string naming the URL.
9295
9296@item gnus-ctan-url
9297@vindex gnus-ctan-url
9298Top directory of a CTAN (Comprehensive TeX Archive Network) archive used
9299by @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler}.
9300
9301@c Misc stuff
9302
9303@item gnus-article-button-face
9304@vindex gnus-article-button-face
9305Face used on buttons.
9306
9307@item gnus-article-mouse-face
9308@vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
9309Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
9310
9311@end table
9312
9313@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
9314
9315
9316@node Article Button Levels
9317@subsection Article button levels
9318@cindex button levels
9319The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
9320the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
9321buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
9322already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
9323more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
9324you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
9325specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
9326variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
9327
9328@lisp
9329;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
9330(setq gnus-parameters
9331 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
9332 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
9333 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
9334@end lisp
9335
9336@table @code
9337
9338@item gnus-button-browse-level
9339@vindex gnus-button-browse-level
9340Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
9341news URLs. Related variables and functions include
9342@code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
9343@code{browse-url-browser-function}.
9344
9345@item gnus-button-emacs-level
9346@vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
9347Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
9348@code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
9349@code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
9350@code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
9351@code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
9352@code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
9353@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
9354@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
9355@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
9356@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
9357@code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
9358
9359@item gnus-button-man-level
9360@vindex gnus-button-man-level
9361Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9362See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9363
9364@item gnus-button-message-level
9365@vindex gnus-button-message-level
9366Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9367Related variables and functions include
9368@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9369@code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9370@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9371@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
9372
9373@item gnus-button-tex-level
9374@vindex gnus-button-tex-level
9375Controls the display of references to @TeX{} or LaTeX stuff, e.g. for CTAN
9376URLs. See the variables @code{gnus-ctan-url},
9377@code{gnus-button-ctan-handler},
9378@code{gnus-button-ctan-directory-regexp}, and
9379@code{gnus-button-handle-ctan-bogus-regexp}.
9380
9381@end table
9382
9383
9384@node Article Date
9385@subsection Article Date
9386
9387The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9388heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9389when the article was sent.
9390
9391@table @kbd
9392
9393@item W T u
9394@kindex W T u (Summary)
9395@findex gnus-article-date-ut
9396Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9397(@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
9398
9399@item W T i
9400@kindex W T i (Summary)
9401@findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9402@cindex ISO 8601
9403Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9404(@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
9405
9406@item W T l
9407@kindex W T l (Summary)
9408@findex gnus-article-date-local
9409Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
9410
9411@item W T p
9412@kindex W T p (Summary)
9413@findex gnus-article-date-english
9414Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9415(@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
9416
9417@item W T s
9418@kindex W T s (Summary)
9419@vindex gnus-article-time-format
9420@findex gnus-article-date-user
9421@findex format-time-string
9422Display the date using a user-defined format
9423(@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9424@code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9425to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9426for a list of possible format specs.
9427
9428@item W T e
9429@kindex W T e (Summary)
9430@findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9431@findex gnus-start-date-timer
9432@findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9433Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9434(@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9435
9436@example
9437X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9438@end example
9439
9440@vindex gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header
9441The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
9442whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
9443replace it.
9444
9445An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
9446into wonderful absurdities.
9447
9448If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
9449
9450@lisp
9451(gnus-start-date-timer)
9452@end lisp
9453
9454in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
9455you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
9456command.
9457
9458@item W T o
9459@kindex W T o (Summary)
9460@findex gnus-article-date-original
9461Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9462be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9463worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9464that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9465@emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9466
9467@end table
9468
9469@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9470preferred format automatically.
9471
9472
9473@node Article Display
9474@subsection Article Display
9475@cindex picons
9476@cindex x-face
9477@cindex smileys
9478
9479These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9480buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9481
9482@code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9483message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9484
9485@code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9486headers (@pxref{Face}).
9487
9488Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9489their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9490
9491Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9492try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9493
9494All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9495they'll be removed.
9496
9497@table @kbd
9498@item W D x
9499@kindex W D x (Summary)
9500@findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9501Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9502(@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9503
9504@item W D d
9505@kindex W D d (Summary)
9506@findex gnus-article-display-face
9507Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9508(@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9509
9510@item W D s
9511@kindex W D s (Summary)
9512@findex gnus-treat-smiley
9513Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9514
9515@item W D f
9516@kindex W D f (Summary)
9517@findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9518Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9519
9520@item W D m
9521@kindex W D m (Summary)
9522@findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9523Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9524(@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9525
9526@item W D n
9527@kindex W D n (Summary)
9528@findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9529Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9530@code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9531
9532@item W D D
9533@kindex W D D (Summary)
9534@findex gnus-article-remove-images
9535Remove all images from the article buffer
9536(@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9537
9538@end table
9539
9540
9541
9542@node Article Signature
9543@subsection Article Signature
9544@cindex signatures
9545@cindex article signature
9546
9547@vindex gnus-signature-separator
9548Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9549body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9550that says what is to be considered a signature is
9551@code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9552@samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9553non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9554of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9555from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9556
9557@lisp
9558(setq gnus-signature-separator
9559 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9560 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9561 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9562 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9563 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9564 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9565 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9566@end lisp
9567
9568The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9569positives.
9570
9571@vindex gnus-signature-limit
9572@code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9573signature when displaying articles.
9574
9575@enumerate
9576@item
9577If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9578that integer.
9579@item
9580If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9581than that number.
9582@item
9583If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9584and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9585@item
9586If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9587in question is not a signature.
9588@end enumerate
9589
9590This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9591listed above. Here's an example:
9592
9593@lisp
9594(setq gnus-signature-limit
9595 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9596@end lisp
9597
9598This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9599separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9600the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9601signature after all.
9602
9603
9604@node Article Miscellanea
9605@subsection Article Miscellanea
9606
9607@table @kbd
9608@item A t
9609@kindex A t (Summary)
9610@findex gnus-article-babel
9611Translate the article from one language to another
9612(@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9613
9614@end table
9615
9616
9617@node MIME Commands
9618@section MIME Commands
9619@cindex MIME decoding
9620@cindex attachments
9621@cindex viewing attachments
9622
9623The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
01c52d31 9624instance, @kbd{3 K v} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
4009494e
GM
9625
9626@table @kbd
9627@item b
9628@itemx K v
9629@kindex b (Summary)
9630@kindex K v (Summary)
9631View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9632
9633@item K o
9634@kindex K o (Summary)
9635Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9636
01c52d31
MB
9637@item K O
9638@kindex K O (Summary)
9639Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} part and strip it
9640from the article. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred
9641via the message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
9642
9643@item K r
9644@kindex K r (Summary)
9645Replace the @acronym{MIME} part with an external body.
9646
9647@item K d
9648@kindex K d (Summary)
9649Delete the @acronym{MIME} part and add some information about the
9650removed part.
9651
4009494e
GM
9652@item K c
9653@kindex K c (Summary)
9654Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9655
9656@item K e
9657@kindex K e (Summary)
9658View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9659
9660@item K i
9661@kindex K i (Summary)
9662View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9663
9664@item K |
9665@kindex K | (Summary)
9666Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9667@end table
9668
9669The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9670the same manner:
9671
9672@table @kbd
9673@item K b
9674@kindex K b (Summary)
9675Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9676mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9677parts.
9678
9679@item K m
9680@kindex K m (Summary)
9681@findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9682Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9683This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9684be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9685(@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9686
9687@item X m
9688@kindex X m (Summary)
9689@findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9690Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9691(@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9692convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9693
9694@item M-t
9695@kindex M-t (Summary)
9696@findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9697Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9698(@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9699
9700@item W M w
9701@kindex W M w (Summary)
9702@findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9703Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9704(@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9705
9706@item W M c
9707@kindex W M c (Summary)
9708@findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9709Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9710(@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9711
9712This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9713charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9714prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9715groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9716include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9717parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9718
9719@item W M v
9720@kindex W M v (Summary)
9721@findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9722View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9723(@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9724
9725@end table
9726
9727Relevant variables:
9728
9729@table @code
9730@item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9731@vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9732This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9733this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9734@code{nil}.
9735
9736To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9737
9738@lisp
9739(setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9740 '("text/x-vcard"))
9741@end lisp
9742
9743@item gnus-article-loose-mime
9744@vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9745If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9746before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9747when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
b890d447 9748default is @code{t}.
4009494e
GM
9749
9750@item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9751@vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9752@cindex uuencode
9753@cindex yEnc
9754There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9755is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9756this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9757see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9758Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
9759single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
9760for encoding in Gnus.
9761
9762@item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9763@vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9764This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9765this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9766displayed or this variable is overridden by
9767@code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9768@code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9769@code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9770
9771@item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9772@vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9773This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9774this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9775displayed. This variable overrides
9776@code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9777This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9778is @code{nil}.
9779
9780To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9781variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9782@code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9783
9784You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9785display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9786those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9787(@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9788Emacs MIME Manual}).
9789
9790@item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9791@vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9792If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9793default value is @code{nil}.
9794
9795@item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9796@vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9797For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9798handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9799users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
9800the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
9801save all jpegs into some directory).
9802
9803Here's an example function the does the latter:
9804
9805@lisp
9806(defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9807 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9808 (with-temp-buffer
9809 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9810 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9811 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9812(setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9813 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9814@end lisp
9815
9816@vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9817@item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9818Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9819
9820@vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9821@item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9822Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9823
9824@vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9825@item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9826Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9827
9828If displaying "text/html" is discouraged, see
9829@code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9830"multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9831@code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9832emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9833
9834@vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9835@item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9836Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9837overrides @code{nil} values of
9838@code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9839@code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9840
9841@vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9842@item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9843List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9844Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9845
9846Ready-made functions include@*
9847@code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9848@code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9849@code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9850@code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9851the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9852whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9853is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9854@findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9855@findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9856@findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9857@findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9858@vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9859
9860The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9861@code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9862
9863Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9864except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9865such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9866
9867@lisp
9868(setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9869 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9870 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9871 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9872@end lisp
9873
9874@noindent
9875to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9876
9877@end table
9878
9879
9880@node Charsets
9881@section Charsets
9882@cindex charsets
9883
9884People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9885charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9886newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9887just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9888help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
9889what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
9890hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
9891
9892@vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
9893This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
9894variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
9895group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
9896
9897@vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
9898In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
9899aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
9900even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
9901@code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
9902charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
9903set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
9904Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
9905which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
9906
9907@vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
9908When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
9909determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
9910encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
9911quoted-printable header encoding.
9912
9913This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
9914for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
9915header body-list}@code{)}, where:
9916
9917@table @var
9918@item test
9919is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
9920variable to query,
9921@item header
9922is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
9923means encode all charsets),
9924@item body-list
9925is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
9926encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
9927encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
9928@end table
9929
9930@cindex Russian
9931@cindex koi8-r
9932@cindex koi8-u
9933@cindex iso-8859-5
9934@cindex coding system aliases
9935@cindex preferred charset
9936
9937@xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
9938The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
9939MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
9940
9941Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
9942
9943If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
9944charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
9945
9946@lisp
9947(put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
9948 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
9949@end lisp
9950
9951This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
9952the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
9953
9954If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
9955
9956@lisp
9957(define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
9958@end lisp
9959
9960This will almost do the right thing.
9961
9962And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
9963something like
9964
9965@lisp
9966(codepage-setup 1251)
9967(define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
9968@end lisp
9969
9970
9971@node Article Commands
9972@section Article Commands
9973
9974@table @kbd
9975
9976@item A P
9977@cindex PostScript
9978@cindex printing
9979@kindex A P (Summary)
9980@vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
9981@findex gnus-summary-print-article
9982Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
9983(@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
9984be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
9985article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
9986
9987@end table
9988
9989
9990@node Summary Sorting
9991@section Summary Sorting
9992@cindex summary sorting
9993
9994You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
9995can't really see why you'd want that.
9996
9997@table @kbd
9998
9999@item C-c C-s C-n
10000@kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10001@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
10002Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
10003
10004@item C-c C-s C-a
10005@kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
10006@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
10007Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
10008
01c52d31
MB
10009@item C-c C-s C-t
10010@kindex C-c C-s C-t (Summary)
10011@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient
10012Sort by recipient (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient}).
10013
4009494e
GM
10014@item C-c C-s C-s
10015@kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
10016@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
10017Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
10018
10019@item C-c C-s C-d
10020@kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
10021@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
10022Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
10023
10024@item C-c C-s C-l
10025@kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
10026@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
10027Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
10028
10029@item C-c C-s C-c
10030@kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
10031@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
10032Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
10033
10034@item C-c C-s C-i
10035@kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
10036@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
10037Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
10038
10039@item C-c C-s C-r
10040@kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
10041@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
10042Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
10043
10044@item C-c C-s C-o
10045@kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
10046@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
10047Sort using the default sorting method
10048(@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
10049@end table
10050
10051These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
10052use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
10053line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
10054root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
10055toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
10056Commands}).
10057
10058
10059@node Finding the Parent
10060@section Finding the Parent
10061@cindex parent articles
10062@cindex referring articles
10063
10064@table @kbd
10065@item ^
10066@kindex ^ (Summary)
10067@findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
10068If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
10069displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
10070if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
10071and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
10072can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
10073(@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
10074you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
10075summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
10076
10077If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
10078the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
10079ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
10080grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
10081@kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
10082article.
10083
10084@item A R (Summary)
10085@findex gnus-summary-refer-references
10086@kindex A R (Summary)
10087Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
10088article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
10089
10090@item A T (Summary)
10091@findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
10092@kindex A T (Summary)
10093Display the full thread where the current article appears
10094(@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
10095headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
10096you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
10097to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
10098visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
10099faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
10100
10101@vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
10102The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
10103articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
10104fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
10105the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
10106by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
10107
10108@item M-^ (Summary)
10109@findex gnus-summary-refer-article
10110@kindex M-^ (Summary)
10111@cindex Message-ID
10112@cindex fetching by Message-ID
10113You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
10114belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
10115for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
10116thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
10117You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
10118
10119Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
10120been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
10121@code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
10122@end table
10123
10124@vindex gnus-refer-article-method
10125If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
10126support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
10127you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
10128would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
10129updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
10130necessary.
10131
10132It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
10133@code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
10134is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
10135match.
10136
10137Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
10138then ask Google if that fails:
10139
10140@lisp
10141(setq gnus-refer-article-method
10142 '(current
10143 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
10144@end lisp
10145
10146Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
10147do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
10148@code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
10149articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
10150only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
10151group. (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does
10152not support this at all.
10153
10154
10155@node Alternative Approaches
10156@section Alternative Approaches
10157
10158Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
10159Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
10160
10161@menu
10162* Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
10163* Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
10164@end menu
10165
10166
10167@node Pick and Read
10168@subsection Pick and Read
10169@cindex pick and read
10170
10171Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
10172a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
10173buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
10174articles with just an article buffer displayed.
10175
10176@findex gnus-pick-mode
10177@kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
10178Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
10179this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
10180mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
10181it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
10182
10183Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
10184
10185@table @kbd
10186@item .
10187@kindex . (Pick)
10188@findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
10189Pick the article or thread on the current line
10190(@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10191@code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
10192entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
10193it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
10194thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
10195at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
10196
10197@item SPACE
10198@kindex SPACE (Pick)
10199@findex gnus-pick-next-page
10200Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
10201at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
10202
10203@item u
10204@kindex u (Pick)
10205@findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
10206Unpick the thread or article
10207(@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10208@code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
10209thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
10210just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
10211the thread or article at that line.
10212
10213@item RET
10214@kindex RET (Pick)
10215@findex gnus-pick-start-reading
10216@vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
10217Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
10218given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
10219@code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
10220will still be visible when you are reading.
10221
10222@end table
10223
10224All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
10225pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
10226which is mapped to the same function
10227@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
10228
10229If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
10230
10231@lisp
10232(add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
10233@end lisp
10234
10235@vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
10236@code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
10237
10238@vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
10239If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
10240all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
10241
10242@vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
10243The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
10244standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
10245displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
10246@code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
10247Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
10248@code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
10249
10250
10251@node Binary Groups
10252@subsection Binary Groups
10253@cindex binary groups
10254
10255@findex gnus-binary-mode
10256@kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
10257If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
10258@kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
10259is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
10260selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
10261instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
10262
10263@kindex g (Binary)
10264@findex gnus-binary-show-article
10265The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
10266command, when you have turned on this mode
10267(@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
10268
10269@vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
10270@code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
10271
10272
10273@node Tree Display
10274@section Tree Display
10275@cindex trees
10276
10277@vindex gnus-use-trees
10278If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
10279@code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
10280additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
10281in the tree buffer.
10282
10283There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
10284
10285@table @code
10286@item gnus-tree-mode-hook
10287@vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
10288A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
10289
10290@item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10291@vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10292A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
10293Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
10294of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
10295
10296@item gnus-selected-tree-face
10297@vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
10298Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
10299default is @code{modeline}.
10300
10301@item gnus-tree-line-format
10302@vindex gnus-tree-line-format
10303A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
10304though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
10305is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
10306the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
10307length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
10308
10309Valid specs are:
10310
10311@table @samp
10312@item n
10313The name of the poster.
10314@item f
10315The @code{From} header.
10316@item N
10317The number of the article.
10318@item [
10319The opening bracket.
10320@item ]
10321The closing bracket.
10322@item s
10323The subject.
10324@end table
10325
10326@xref{Formatting Variables}.
10327
10328Variables related to the display are:
10329
10330@table @code
10331@item gnus-tree-brackets
10332@vindex gnus-tree-brackets
10333This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
10334``sparse'' articles. The format is
10335@example
10336((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
10337 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
10338 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
10339@end example
10340and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
10341
10342@item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10343@vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10344This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
10345nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
10346
10347@end table
10348
10349@item gnus-tree-minimize-window
10350@vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
10351If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
10352buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
10353windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
10354higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
10355have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
10356buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
10357other windows displayed next to it.
10358
10359You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
10360at all times:
10361
10362@lisp
10363(add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
10364 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
10365@end lisp
10366
10367@item gnus-generate-tree-function
10368@vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
10369@findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10370@findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
10371The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
10372functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
10373@code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
10374
10375@end table
10376
10377Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
10378
10379@example
10380@{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
10381 | \[Jan]
10382 | \[odd]-[Eri]
10383 | \(***)-[Eri]
10384 | \[odd]-[Paa]
10385 \[Bjo]
10386 \[Gun]
10387 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10388@end example
10389
10390Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
10391
10392@example
10393@group
10394@{***@}
10395 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10396(***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10397 |--\-----\-----\ |
10398[odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10399 | | |--\
10400[Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10401 |
10402 [Paa]
10403@end group
10404@end example
10405
10406If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10407side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10408following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
10409
10410@lisp
10411(setq gnus-use-trees t
10412 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10413 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10414(gnus-add-configuration
10415 '(article
10416 (vertical 1.0
10417 (horizontal 0.25
10418 (summary 0.75 point)
10419 (tree 1.0))
10420 (article 1.0))))
10421@end lisp
10422
10423@xref{Window Layout}.
10424
10425
10426@node Mail Group Commands
10427@section Mail Group Commands
10428@cindex mail group commands
10429
10430Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10431invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
10432
10433All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10434process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10435
10436@table @kbd
10437
10438@item B e
10439@kindex B e (Summary)
10440@findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10441@cindex expiring mail
10442Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10443process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10444expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10445(@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
10446
10447@item B C-M-e
10448@kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10449@findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10450@cindex expiring mail
10451Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10452(@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10453articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10454disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
10455
10456@item B DEL
10457@kindex B DEL (Summary)
10458@findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10459@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10460Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10461disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10462(@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10463
10464@item B m
10465@kindex B m (Summary)
10466@cindex move mail
10467@findex gnus-summary-move-article
10468@vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10469Move the article from one mail group to another
10470(@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10471@code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10472
10473@item B c
10474@kindex B c (Summary)
10475@cindex copy mail
10476@findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10477@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10478Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10479(@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10480@code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10481
10482@item B B
10483@kindex B B (Summary)
10484@cindex crosspost mail
10485@findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10486Crosspost the current article to some other group
10487(@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10488the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10489be properly updated.
10490
10491@item B i
10492@kindex B i (Summary)
10493@findex gnus-summary-import-article
10494Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10495(@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10496name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10497
10498@item B I
10499@kindex B I (Summary)
10500@findex gnus-summary-create-article
10501Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10502(@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10503@code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10504
10505@item B r
10506@kindex B r (Summary)
10507@findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10508@vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10509Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10510@code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10511select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10512which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10513Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10514(which is the default).
10515
10516@item B w
10517@itemx e
10518@kindex B w (Summary)
10519@kindex e (Summary)
10520@findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10521@kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10522@findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10523Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10524editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10525(@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10526@kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10527
10528@item B q
10529@kindex B q (Summary)
10530@findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10531If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10532the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10533will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10534
10535@item B t
10536@kindex B t (Summary)
10537@findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10538Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10539when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10540
10541@item B p
10542@kindex B p (Summary)
10543@findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10544Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10545follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10546@code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10547(@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10548article from your news server (or rather, from
10549@code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10550report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10551it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10552propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10553just not have arrived yet.
10554
10555@item K E
10556@kindex K E (Summary)
10557@findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10558@vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10559Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10560The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10561variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10562
10563@end table
10564
10565@vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10566@cindex moving articles
10567If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10568suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10569variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10570(@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10571suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10572@code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10573@code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10574
10575@lisp
10576(setq gnus-move-split-methods
10577 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10578 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10579 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10580@end lisp
10581
10582
10583@node Various Summary Stuff
10584@section Various Summary Stuff
10585
10586@menu
10587* Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10588* Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10589* Summary Generation Commands::
10590* Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10591@end menu
10592
10593@table @code
10594@vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10595@item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10596If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10597built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10598If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10599lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10600
10601@vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10602@item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10603If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10604current article.
10605
10606@vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10607@item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10608This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10609
10610@vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10611@item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10612This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10613generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10614the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10615is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10616have been set.
10617
10618@vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10619@item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10620It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10621it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10622some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10623
10624@vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10625@item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10626A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10627generated.
10628
10629@vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10630@item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10631When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10632it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10633same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10634sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10635If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10636@code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10637any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10638article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10639
10640@vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10641@item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10642This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10643of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10644list of articles to be selected.
10645
10646For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10647the list in one particular group:
10648
10649@lisp
10650(defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10651 (if (string= group "some.group")
10652 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10653 articles))
10654@end lisp
10655
10656@vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10657@item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10658A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10659variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10660values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10661buffer is active.
10662
10663Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10664@code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10665assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10666that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10667variable will be used instead.
10668
10669These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10670while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10671buffers. For example:
10672
10673@lisp
10674(setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10675 '(message-use-followup-to
10676 (gnus-visible-headers .
10677 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10678@end lisp
10679
10680Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10681@end table
10682
10683
10684@node Summary Group Information
10685@subsection Summary Group Information
10686
10687@table @kbd
10688
10689@item H f
10690@kindex H f (Summary)
10691@findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
10692@vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
10693Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} (list of frequently asked questions)
10694for the current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try
10695to get the @acronym{FAQ} from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which
10696is usually a directory on a remote machine. This variable can also be
10697a list of directories. In that case, giving a prefix to this command
10698will allow you to choose between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp}
10699or @code{efs} will probably be used for fetching the file.
10700
10701@item H d
10702@kindex H d (Summary)
10703@findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10704Give a brief description of the current group
10705(@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10706rereading the description from the server.
10707
10708@item H h
10709@kindex H h (Summary)
10710@findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10711Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10712keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10713
10714@item H i
10715@kindex H i (Summary)
10716@findex gnus-info-find-node
10717Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10718@end table
10719
10720
10721@node Searching for Articles
10722@subsection Searching for Articles
10723
10724@table @kbd
10725
10726@item M-s
10727@kindex M-s (Summary)
10728@findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10729Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10730(@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10731
10732@item M-r
10733@kindex M-r (Summary)
10734@findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10735Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10736(@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10737
01c52d31
MB
10738@item M-S
10739@kindex M-S (Summary)
10740@findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward
10741Repeat the previous search forwards
10742(@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward}).
10743
10744@item M-R
10745@kindex M-R (Summary)
10746@findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward
10747Repeat the previous search backwards
10748(@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward}).
10749
4009494e
GM
10750@item &
10751@kindex & (Summary)
10752@findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10753This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10754on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10755(@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10756string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10757search backward instead.
10758
10759For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10760all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10761
10762@item M-&
10763@kindex M-& (Summary)
10764@findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10765Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10766the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10767@end table
10768
10769@node Summary Generation Commands
10770@subsection Summary Generation Commands
10771
10772@table @kbd
10773
10774@item Y g
10775@kindex Y g (Summary)
10776@findex gnus-summary-prepare
10777Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10778
10779@item Y c
10780@kindex Y c (Summary)
10781@findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10782Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10783(@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10784
10785@item Y d
10786@kindex Y d (Summary)
10787@findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10788Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10789(@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10790
01c52d31
MB
10791@item Y t
10792@kindex Y t (Summary)
10793@findex gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles
10794Pull all ticked articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10795(@code{gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles}).
10796
4009494e
GM
10797@end table
10798
10799
10800@node Really Various Summary Commands
10801@subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10802
10803@table @kbd
10804
10805@item A D
10806@itemx C-d
10807@kindex C-d (Summary)
10808@kindex A D (Summary)
10809@findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10810If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10811a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10812article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10813guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10814to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10815whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10816some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10817fashion.
10818
01c52d31
MB
10819@vindex gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit
10820The variable @code{gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit} controls what
10821article should be selected after exiting a digest group. Valid values
10822include:
10823
10824@table @code
10825@item next
10826Select the next article.
10827
10828@item next-unread
10829Select the next unread article.
10830
10831@item next-noselect
10832Move the cursor to the next article. This is the default.
10833
10834@item next-unread-noselect
10835Move the cursor to the next unread article.
10836@end table
10837
10838If it has any other value or there is no next (unread) article, the
10839article selected before entering to the digest group will appear.
10840
4009494e
GM
10841@item C-M-d
10842@kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10843@findex gnus-summary-read-document
10844This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10845several documents into one biiig group
10846(@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10847@code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10848@code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10849command understands the process/prefix convention
10850(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10851
10852@item C-t
10853@kindex C-t (Summary)
10854@findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10855Toggle truncation of summary lines
10856(@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10857line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10858to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10859
10860@item =
10861@kindex = (Summary)
10862@findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10863Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10864If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10865
10866@item C-M-e
10867@kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10868@findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10869Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10870group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10871
10872@item C-M-a
10873@kindex C-M-a (Summary)
10874@findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
10875Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10876group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
10877
10878@end table
10879
10880
10881@node Exiting the Summary Buffer
10882@section Exiting the Summary Buffer
10883@cindex summary exit
10884@cindex exiting groups
10885
10886Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
10887group and return you to the group buffer.
10888
10889@table @kbd
10890
10891@item Z Z
10892@itemx Z Q
10893@itemx q
10894@kindex Z Z (Summary)
10895@kindex Z Q (Summary)
10896@kindex q (Summary)
10897@findex gnus-summary-exit
10898@vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
10899@vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
10900@vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
10901@c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
10902Exit the current group and update all information on the group
10903(@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
10904called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
10905@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
10906@code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
10907process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
10908group mode having no more (unread) groups.
10909
10910@item Z E
10911@itemx Q
10912@kindex Z E (Summary)
10913@kindex Q (Summary)
10914@findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
10915Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
10916(@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
10917
10918@item Z c
10919@itemx c
10920@kindex Z c (Summary)
10921@kindex c (Summary)
10922@findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
10923@c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
10924Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
10925(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
10926
10927@item Z C
10928@kindex Z C (Summary)
10929@findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
10930Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
10931(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
10932
10933@item Z n
10934@kindex Z n (Summary)
10935@findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
10936Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
10937(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
10938
01c52d31
MB
10939@item Z p
10940@kindex Z p (Summary)
10941@findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group
10942Mark all articles as read and go to the previous group
10943(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group}).
10944
4009494e
GM
10945@item Z R
10946@itemx C-x C-s
10947@kindex Z R (Summary)
10948@kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
10949@findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
10950Exit this group, and then enter it again
10951(@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
10952all articles, both read and unread.
10953
10954@item Z G
10955@itemx M-g
10956@kindex Z G (Summary)
10957@kindex M-g (Summary)
10958@findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
10959@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
10960Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
10961group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
10962articles, both read and unread.
10963
10964@item Z N
10965@kindex Z N (Summary)
10966@findex gnus-summary-next-group
10967Exit the group and go to the next group
10968(@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
10969
10970@item Z P
10971@kindex Z P (Summary)
10972@findex gnus-summary-prev-group
10973Exit the group and go to the previous group
10974(@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
10975
10976@item Z s
10977@kindex Z s (Summary)
10978@findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
10979Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
10980and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
10981given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
10982command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
10983@end table
10984
10985@vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
10986@code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
10987with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
10988(@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
10989
10990@findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
10991@findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
10992@vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
10993If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
10994about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
10995If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
10996(Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
10997something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
10998called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
10999buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
11000@code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
11001summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
11002
11003There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
11004
11005@vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
11006The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
11007read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
11008summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
11009@code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
11010this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
11011other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
11012neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
11013both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
11014
11015
11016@node Crosspost Handling
11017@section Crosspost Handling
11018
11019@cindex velveeta
11020@cindex spamming
11021Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
11022read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
11023posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
11024several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
11025by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
11026heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
11027(@pxref{NoCeM}).
11028
11029Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
11030separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
11031@dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
11032@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
11033excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
11034
11035@cindex cross-posting
11036@cindex Xref
11037@cindex @acronym{NOV}
11038One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
11039correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
11040(which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
11041does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
11042Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
11043even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
11044articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
11045them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
11046the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
11047the cross reference mechanism.
11048
11049@cindex LIST overview.fmt
11050@cindex overview.fmt
11051To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
11052in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
11053@samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
11054overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
11055get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
11056your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
11057overview files.
11058
4009494e 11059If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
4b70e299
MB
11060set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
11061considerably. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
4009494e
GM
11062
11063C'est la vie.
11064
11065For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
11066
11067
11068@node Duplicate Suppression
11069@section Duplicate Suppression
11070
11071By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
11072article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
11073(@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
11074approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
11075reasons.
11076
11077@enumerate
11078@item
11079The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
11080is evil and not very common.
11081
11082@item
11083The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
11084@file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
11085
11086@item
11087You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
11088different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
11089
11090@item
11091You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
11092@end enumerate
11093
11094I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
11095well, but these four are the most common situations.
11096
11097If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
11098consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
11099will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
11100otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
11101all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
11102mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
11103so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
11104once.
11105
11106Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
11107sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
11108fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
11109to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
11110article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
11111saw the article in.
11112
11113@table @code
11114@item gnus-suppress-duplicates
11115@vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
11116If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
11117
11118@item gnus-save-duplicate-list
11119@vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
11120If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
11121make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
11122However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
11123session are suppressed.
11124
11125@item gnus-duplicate-list-length
11126@vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
11127This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
11128suppression list. The default is 10000.
11129
11130@item gnus-duplicate-file
11131@vindex gnus-duplicate-file
11132The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
11133default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
11134@end table
11135
11136If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
11137@code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
11138you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
11139the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
11140so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
11141@code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
11142to you to figure out, I think.
11143
11144@node Security
11145@section Security
11146
11147Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
11148The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
11149and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
11150things to work:
11151
11152@enumerate
11153@item
11154To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
11155install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
11156to GnuPG included with Gnus is called PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg, PGG
11157Manual}), but Mailcrypt and gpg.el are also supported.
11158
11159@item
11160To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
11161or newer is recommended.
11162
11163@end enumerate
11164
11165The variables that control security functionality on reading messages
11166include:
11167
11168@table @code
11169@item mm-verify-option
11170@vindex mm-verify-option
11171Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
11172@code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
11173protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11174
11175@item mm-decrypt-option
11176@vindex mm-decrypt-option
11177Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
11178@code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
11179protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11180
11181@item mml1991-use
11182@vindex mml1991-use
11183Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11184@acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
11185@code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
11186deprecated.
11187
11188@item mml2015-use
11189@vindex mml2015-use
11190Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11191@acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
11192@code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
11193deprecated.
11194
11195@end table
11196
11197By default the buttons that display security information are not
11198shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
11199@kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
11200@code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
11201@code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
11202permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
11203how to customize these variables to always display security
11204information.
11205
11206@cindex snarfing keys
11207@cindex importing PGP keys
11208@cindex PGP key ring import
11209Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
11210key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
11211rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
11212allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
11213through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
11214@file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
11215Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
11216Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
11217(@pxref{Using MIME}).
11218
11219@example
11220application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
11221@end example
11222@noindent
11223This happens to also be the default action defined in
11224@code{mailcap-mime-data}.
11225
11226More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
11227encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
11228(@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
11229
11230@node Mailing List
11231@section Mailing List
11232@cindex mailing list
11233@cindex RFC 2396
11234
11235@kindex A M (summary)
11236@findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
11237Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
11238add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
11239possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
11240summary buffer.
11241
11242That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
11243
11244@table @kbd
11245
11246@item C-c C-n h
11247@kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
11248@findex gnus-mailing-list-help
11249Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
11250
11251@item C-c C-n s
11252@kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
11253@findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
11254Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
11255
11256@item C-c C-n u
11257@kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
11258@findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
11259Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
11260field exists.
11261
11262@item C-c C-n p
11263@kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
11264@findex gnus-mailing-list-post
11265Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
11266
11267@item C-c C-n o
11268@kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
11269@findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
11270Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
11271
11272@item C-c C-n a
11273@kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
01c52d31 11274@findex gnus-mailing-list-archive
4009494e
GM
11275Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
11276
11277@end table
11278
11279
11280@node Article Buffer
11281@chapter Article Buffer
11282@cindex article buffer
11283
11284The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
11285one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
11286tell Gnus otherwise.
11287
11288@menu
11289* Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
11290* Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
11291* Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
11292* Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
11293* Misc Article:: Other stuff.
11294@end menu
11295
11296
11297@node Hiding Headers
11298@section Hiding Headers
11299@cindex hiding headers
11300@cindex deleting headers
11301
11302The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
11303@dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
11304
11305@vindex gnus-show-all-headers
11306There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
11307who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
11308article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
11309most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
11310through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
11311@code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
11312of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
11313article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
11314
11315Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
11316
11317@table @code
11318
11319@item gnus-visible-headers
11320@vindex gnus-visible-headers
11321If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
11322that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
11323headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
11324
11325For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
11326the article and the subject, you'd say:
11327
11328@lisp
11329(setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
11330@end lisp
11331
11332This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11333remain visible.
11334
11335@item gnus-ignored-headers
11336@vindex gnus-ignored-headers
11337This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
11338variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
11339should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
11340hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
11341
11342For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
11343and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
11344
11345@lisp
11346(setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
11347@end lisp
11348
11349This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11350be removed.
11351
11352Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
11353variable will have no effect.
11354
11355@end table
11356
11357@vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
11358Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
11359can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
11360variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
11361the headers are to be displayed.
11362
11363For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
11364and then the subject, you might say something like:
11365
11366@lisp
11367(setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
11368@end lisp
11369
11370Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
11371variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
11372
11373@findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
11374@vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
11375You can hide further boring headers by setting
11376@code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
11377does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
11378list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
11379lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
11380from sight.
11381
11382These conditions are:
11383@table @code
11384@item empty
11385Remove all empty headers.
11386@item followup-to
11387Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
11388@code{Newsgroups} header.
11389@item reply-to
11390Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
11391the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
11392parameter is set.
11393@item newsgroups
11394Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
11395name.
11396@item to-address
11397Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11398the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
11399@item to-list
11400Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11401the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11402@item cc-list
11403Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
11404the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11405@item date
11406Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
11407old.
11408@item long-to
11409Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
11410@item many-to
11411Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
11412@end table
11413
11414To include these three elements, you could say something like:
11415
11416@lisp
11417(setq gnus-boring-article-headers
11418 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
11419@end lisp
11420
11421This is also the default value for this variable.
11422
11423
11424@node Using MIME
11425@section Using MIME
11426@cindex @acronym{MIME}
11427
11428Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
11429while people stand around yawning.
11430
11431@acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
11432while all newsreaders die of fear.
11433
11434@acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11435of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11436other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
11437
11438@vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11439@findex gnus-display-mime
11440Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11441to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11442default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11443display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
11444
11445The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11446@acronym{MIME} button:
11447
11448@table @kbd
11449@findex gnus-article-press-button
11450@item RET (Article)
11451@kindex RET (Article)
11452@itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11453Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11454(@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11455the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11456files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11457object is displayed inline.
11458
11459@findex gnus-mime-view-part
11460@item M-RET (Article)
11461@kindex M-RET (Article)
11462@itemx v (Article)
11463Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11464method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11465
11466@findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11467@item t (Article)
11468@kindex t (Article)
11469View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11470(@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11471
11472@findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11473@item C (Article)
11474@kindex C (Article)
11475Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11476charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
11477
11478@findex gnus-mime-save-part
11479@item o (Article)
11480@kindex o (Article)
11481Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11482(@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
11483
11484@findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11485@item C-o (Article)
11486@kindex C-o (Article)
11487Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11488the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11489suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11490like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11491message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11492(@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
11493
01c52d31
MB
11494@findex gnus-mime-replace-part
11495@item r (Article)
11496@kindex r (Article)
11497Prompt for a file name, replace the @acronym{MIME} object with an
11498external body refering to the file via the message/external-body
11499@acronym{MIME} type. (@code{gnus-mime-replace-part}).
11500
4009494e
GM
11501@findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11502@item d (Article)
11503@kindex d (Article)
11504Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11505information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11506(@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
11507
01c52d31
MB
11508@c FIXME: gnus-auto-select-part should be documented here
11509
4009494e
GM
11510@findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11511@item c (Article)
11512@kindex c (Article)
11513Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
01c52d31
MB
11514(@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). If given a prefix, copy the raw contents
11515without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual
11516charset stuff (see @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in
11517@ref{Paging the Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
4009494e
GM
11518@file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11519@code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11520Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11521
11522@findex gnus-mime-print-part
11523@item p (Article)
11524@kindex p (Article)
11525Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11526command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11527@file{.mailcap} file.
11528
11529@findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11530@item i (Article)
11531@kindex i (Article)
11532Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11533(@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as text/plain. If given a prefix, insert
11534the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11535do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11536@code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
01c52d31
MB
11537Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and @file{.bz2} are
11538automatically decompressed depending on @code{jka-compr} regardless of
11539@code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed Files,, Accessing
11540Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
4009494e
GM
11541
11542@findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11543@item E (Article)
11544@kindex E (Article)
11545View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11546viewer is available, use an external viewer
11547(@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11548
11549@findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11550@item e (Article)
11551@kindex e (Article)
11552View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11553(@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11554
11555@findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11556@item | (Article)
11557@kindex | (Article)
11558Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11559
11560@findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11561@item . (Article)
11562@kindex . (Article)
11563Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11564(@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11565
11566@end table
11567
11568Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11569determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11570@acronym{MIME} manual.
11571
11572It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11573buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11574group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11575decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11576comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11577because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11578try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11579to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11580to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11581
11582Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11583
11584Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11585
11586
11587@node Customizing Articles
11588@section Customizing Articles
11589@cindex article customization
11590
11591A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11592exist. You can call these functions interactively
11593(@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11594called automatically when you select the articles.
11595
11596To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11597``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11598@code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11599be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11600
11601Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11602for sensible values.
11603
11604@enumerate
11605@item
11606@code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11607
11608@item
11609@code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11610
11611@item
11612@code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11613
11614@item
01c52d31
MB
11615@code{first}: Do this treatment on the first body part.
11616
11617@item
11618@code{last}: Do this treatment on the last body part.
4009494e
GM
11619
11620@item
11621An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11622than this number.
11623
11624@item
11625A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11626articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11627regexps in the list.
11628
11629@item
11630A list where the first element is not a string:
11631
11632The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11633predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11634@code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11635
11636@lisp
11637(or last
11638 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11639@end lisp
11640
11641@end enumerate
11642
11643You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11644to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11645be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11646considered to contain just a single part.
11647
11648@vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11649Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11650want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11651treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11652variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11653type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11654controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11655
11656@ifinfo
11657@c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
11658@c manual, but add them in info to allow `i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
11659@c `i foo-bar'.
11660@vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
11661@vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
11662@vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
11663@vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
11664@vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
11665@vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
11666@vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
11667@vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
11668@vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
11669@vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
11670@vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
11671@vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
11672@vindex gnus-treat-date-english
11673@vindex gnus-treat-date-iso8601
11674@vindex gnus-treat-date-lapsed
11675@vindex gnus-treat-date-local
11676@vindex gnus-treat-date-original
11677@vindex gnus-treat-date-user-defined
11678@vindex gnus-treat-date-ut
11679@vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
11680@vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
11681@vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
11682@vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
11683@vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
11684@vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11685@vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11686@vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11687@vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11688@vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11689@vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11690@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11691@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11692@vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11693@vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11694@vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11695@vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11696@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11697@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11698@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11699@vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11700@vindex gnus-treat-translate
11701@vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11702@vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11703@vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11704@vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11705@vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11706@end ifinfo
11707
11708The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11709customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11710group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11711possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11712
11713@table @code
11714@item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11715@item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11716
11717@xref{Article Buttons}.
11718
11719@item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11720@item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11721@item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11722@item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
01c52d31 11723@item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, first, integer)
4009494e
GM
11724@item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11725@item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11726@item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11727@item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11728@item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11729
11730@xref{Article Washing}.
11731
11732@item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
11733@item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
11734@item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
11735@item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
11736@item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
11737@item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
11738@item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
11739
11740@xref{Article Date}.
11741
11742@item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11743@item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11744@item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11745
11746@xref{Picons}.
11747
11748@item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11749
11750@item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11751
11752@vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11753Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11754is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11755
11756@xref{Smileys}.
11757
11758@vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11759@item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11760
11761@xref{X-Face}.
11762
11763@vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11764@item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
11765
11766@xref{Face}.
11767
11768@vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11769@item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
11770@vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11771@item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
11772@vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11773@item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
11774@vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11775@item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
11776@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11777@item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
11778@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11779@item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
11780@vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11781@item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
11782@vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11783@item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
11784@vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11785@item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
11786@vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11787@item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
11788
11789@xref{Article Hiding}.
11790
11791@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11792@item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
11793@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11794@item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
11795@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11796@item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
11797
11798@xref{Article Highlighting}.
11799
11800@vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11801@item gnus-treat-play-sounds
11802@vindex gnus-treat-translate
11803@item gnus-treat-translate
01c52d31 11804@item gnus-treat-ansi-sequences (t)
4009494e
GM
11805@vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11806@item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
11807
11808@vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11809@item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
11810@vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11811@item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
11812@vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11813@item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
11814@vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11815@item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
11816
11817@xref{Article Header}.
11818
11819
11820@end table
11821
11822@vindex gnus-part-display-hook
11823You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
11824@code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
11825part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
11826information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
11827everything.
11828
11829
11830@node Article Keymap
11831@section Article Keymap
11832
11833Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
11834article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
11835buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
11836buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
11837buffer.
11838
11839@kindex v (Article)
11840@cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
11841The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
11842command or better use it as a prefix key.
11843
11844A few additional keystrokes are available:
11845
11846@table @kbd
11847
11848@item SPACE
11849@kindex SPACE (Article)
11850@findex gnus-article-next-page
11851Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
11852This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
11853
11854@item DEL
11855@kindex DEL (Article)
11856@findex gnus-article-prev-page
11857Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
11858This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
11859
11860@item C-c ^
11861@kindex C-c ^ (Article)
11862@findex gnus-article-refer-article
11863If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
11864@kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
11865(@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
11866
11867@item C-c C-m
11868@kindex C-c C-m (Article)
11869@findex gnus-article-mail
11870Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
11871given a prefix, include the mail.
11872
11873@item s
11874@kindex s (Article)
11875@findex gnus-article-show-summary
11876Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
11877(@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
11878
11879@item ?
11880@kindex ? (Article)
11881@findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
11882Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
11883(@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
11884
11885@item TAB
11886@kindex TAB (Article)
11887@findex gnus-article-next-button
11888Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
11889only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
11890
11891@item M-TAB
11892@kindex M-TAB (Article)
11893@findex gnus-article-prev-button
11894Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
11895
11896@item R
11897@kindex R (Article)
11898@findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
11899Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
11900(@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If given a prefix, make a
11901wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11902region.
11903
11904@item F
11905@kindex F (Article)
11906@findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
11907Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
11908(@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If given a prefix, make
11909a wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11910region.
11911
11912
11913@end table
11914
11915
11916@node Misc Article
11917@section Misc Article
11918
11919@table @code
11920
11921@item gnus-single-article-buffer
11922@vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
11923@cindex article buffers, several
11924If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
11925(This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
11926article buffer.
11927
11928@vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
11929@item gnus-article-decode-hook
11930@cindex @acronym{MIME}
11931Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
11932@code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
11933
11934@vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
11935@item gnus-article-prepare-hook
11936This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
11937article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
11938depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
11939the contents of the article buffer.
11940
11941@item gnus-article-mode-hook
11942@vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
11943Hook called in article mode buffers.
11944
11945@item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11946@vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11947Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
11948@code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
11949
11950@vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
11951@item gnus-article-over-scroll
11952If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
11953no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
11954
11955@vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
11956@item gnus-article-mode-line-format
11957This variable is a format string along the same lines as
11958@code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
11959Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
11960with two extensions:
11961
11962@table @samp
11963
11964@item w
11965The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
11966character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
11967performed. The characters and their meaning:
11968
11969@table @samp
11970
11971@item c
11972Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
11973
11974@item h
11975Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
11976
11977@item p
11978Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
11979hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
11980security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
11981
11982@item s
11983Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
11984
11985@item o
11986Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
11987
11988@item e
11989Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasised strings in the article buffer.
11990
11991@end table
11992
11993@item m
11994The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
11995
11996@end table
11997
11998@vindex gnus-break-pages
11999
12000@item gnus-break-pages
12001Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
12002is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
12003page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
12004paging will not be done.
12005
12006@item gnus-page-delimiter
12007@vindex gnus-page-delimiter
12008This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
12009(formfeed).
12010
12011@cindex IDNA
12012@cindex internationalized domain names
12013@vindex gnus-use-idna
12014@item gnus-use-idna
12015This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
12016internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
01c52d31
MB
12017@samp{Cc} headers. @xref{IDNA, ,IDNA,message, The Message Manual},
12018for how to compose such messages. This requires
4009494e
GM
12019@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
12020variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
12021
12022@end table
12023
12024
12025@node Composing Messages
12026@chapter Composing Messages
12027@cindex composing messages
12028@cindex messages
12029@cindex mail
12030@cindex sending mail
12031@cindex reply
12032@cindex followup
12033@cindex post
12034@cindex using gpg
12035@cindex using s/mime
12036@cindex using smime
12037
12038@kindex C-c C-c (Post)
12039All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
12040where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
12041article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
12042Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
12043on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
12044
12045@menu
12046* Mail:: Mailing and replying.
12047* Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
12048* POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
12049* Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
12050* Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
12051* Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
12052* Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
12053* Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
12054* Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
12055@end menu
12056
12057Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
12058remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
12059
12060
12061@node Mail
12062@section Mail
12063
12064Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
12065
12066@table @code
12067@item gnus-uu-digest-headers
12068@vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
12069List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
12070headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
12071@code{nil} include all headers.
12072
12073@item gnus-add-to-list
12074@vindex gnus-add-to-list
12075If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
12076that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
12077
12078@item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12079@vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12080If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
12081about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
12082interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
12083receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
12084non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
12085matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
12086
12087If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
12088press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
12089
12090@item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12091@vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12092If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
12093@code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
12094useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
12095
12096@end table
12097
12098
12099@node Posting Server
12100@section Posting Server
12101
12102When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
12103(extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
12104
12105Thank you for asking. I hate you.
12106
12107It can be quite complicated.
12108
12109@vindex gnus-post-method
12110When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
12111(@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
12112Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
12113reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
12114groups from different private servers). However. If the server
12115you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
12116want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
12117fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
12118@code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
12119
12120@lisp
12121(setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
12122@end lisp
12123
12124Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
12125this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
12126can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
12127the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
12128
12129If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
12130Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
12131
12132You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
12133If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
12134for posting.
12135
12136Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
12137you can set this variable to @code{native}.
12138
12139When sending mail, Message invokes @code{message-send-mail-function}.
12140The default function, @code{message-send-mail-with-sendmail}, pipes
12141your article to the @code{sendmail} binary for further queuing and
12142sending. When your local system is not configured for sending mail
12143using @code{sendmail}, and you have access to a remote @acronym{SMTP}
12144server, you can set @code{message-send-mail-function} to
12145@code{smtpmail-send-it} and make sure to setup the @code{smtpmail}
12146package correctly. An example:
12147
12148@lisp
12149(setq message-send-mail-function 'smtpmail-send-it
12150 smtpmail-default-smtp-server "YOUR SMTP HOST")
12151@end lisp
12152
12153To the thing similar to this, there is
12154@code{message-smtpmail-send-it}. It is useful if your @acronym{ISP}
12155requires the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication.
12156@xref{POP before SMTP}.
12157
12158Other possible choices for @code{message-send-mail-function} includes
12159@code{message-send-mail-with-mh}, @code{message-send-mail-with-qmail},
12160and @code{feedmail-send-it}.
12161
12162@node POP before SMTP
12163@section POP before SMTP
12164@cindex pop before smtp
12165@findex message-smtpmail-send-it
12166@findex mail-source-touch-pop
12167
12168Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
12169authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
12170mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
12171a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
12172@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
12173
12174@lisp
12175(setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
12176(add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
12177@end lisp
12178
12179@noindent
12180It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
12181whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
12182does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
12183@code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
12184Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
12185@code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
12186set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
12187correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
12188
12189If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
12190@code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
12191@code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
12192used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
12193is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
12194mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
12195
12196@lisp
12197(setq mail-source-primary-source
12198 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12199 :password "secret"))
12200@end lisp
12201
12202@noindent
12203Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
12204@acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
12205
12206@lisp
12207(add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
12208 (lambda ()
12209 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
12210 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12211 :password "secret")))
12212 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
12213@end lisp
12214
12215@node Mail and Post
12216@section Mail and Post
12217
12218Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
12219posting:
12220
12221@table @code
12222@item gnus-mailing-list-groups
12223@findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
12224@cindex mailing lists
12225
12226If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
12227gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
12228problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
12229One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
12230(@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
12231@code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
12232really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
12233lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
12234still a pain, though.
12235
12236@item gnus-user-agent
12237@vindex gnus-user-agent
12238@cindex User-Agent
12239
12240This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
12241User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
12242symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
12243version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
12244(show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
12245configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
12246string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
12247
12248@end table
12249
12250You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
12251you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
12252spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
12253
12254@cindex ispell
12255@findex ispell-message
12256@lisp
12257(add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
12258@end lisp
12259
12260If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
12261you're in, you could say something like the following:
12262
12263@lisp
12264(add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
12265 (lambda ()
12266 (cond
12267 ((string-match
12268 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
12269 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
12270 (t
12271 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
12272@end lisp
12273
12274Modify to suit your needs.
12275
01c52d31
MB
12276@vindex gnus-message-highlight-citation
12277If @code{gnus-message-highlight-citation} is t, different levels of
12278citations are highlighted like in Gnus article buffers also in message
12279mode buffers.
4009494e
GM
12280
12281@node Archived Messages
12282@section Archived Messages
12283@cindex archived messages
12284@cindex sent messages
12285
12286Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
12287send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
12288store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
12289@code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
12290is the default.
12291
12292For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
12293@kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
12294Group Commands}).
12295
12296@vindex gnus-message-archive-method
12297@code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
01c52d31
MB
12298use to store sent messages. The default is @code{"archive"}, and when
12299actually being used it is expanded into:
4009494e
GM
12300
12301@lisp
12302(nnfolder "archive"
12303 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
12304 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
12305 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
12306 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
12307@end lisp
12308
01c52d31
MB
12309@quotation
12310@vindex gnus-update-message-archive-method
12311Note: a server like this is saved in the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file first
12312so that it may be used as a real method of the server which is named
12313@code{"archive"} (that is, for the case where
12314@code{gnus-message-archive-method} is set to @code{"archive"}) ever
12315since. If it once has been saved, it will never be updated by default
12316even if you change the value of @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12317afterward. Therefore, the server @code{"archive"} doesn't necessarily
12318mean the @code{nnfolder} server like this at all times. If you want the
12319saved method to reflect always the value of
12320@code{gnus-message-archive-method}, set the
12321@code{gnus-update-message-archive-method} variable to a non-@code{nil}
12322value. The default value of this variable is @code{nil}.
12323@end quotation
12324
4009494e
GM
12325You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
12326@code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
12327for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
12328directory chosen, you could say something like:
12329
12330@lisp
12331(setq gnus-message-archive-method
12332 '(nnfolder "archive"
12333 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
12334 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
12335 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
12336@end lisp
12337
12338@vindex gnus-message-archive-group
12339@cindex Gcc
12340Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
12341to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
12342determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
12343
12344This variable can be used to do the following:
12345
12346@table @asis
12347@item a string
12348Messages will be saved in that group.
12349
12350Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
12351message will not be stored in the select method given by
12352@code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
12353by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12354has the default value shown above. Then setting
12355@code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
12356messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
12357value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
12358@samp{nnml:foo}.
12359
12360@item a list of strings
12361Messages will be saved in all those groups.
12362
12363@item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
12364When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
12365
12366@item @code{nil}
12367No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
12368@end table
12369
12370Let's illustrate:
12371
12372Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
12373@lisp
12374(setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
12375@end lisp
12376
12377Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
12378@lisp
12379(setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
12380@end lisp
12381
12382Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
12383@lisp
12384(setq gnus-message-archive-group
12385 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
12386 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
12387 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
12388@end lisp
12389
12390More complex stuff:
12391@lisp
12392(setq gnus-message-archive-group
12393 '((if (message-news-p)
12394 "misc-news"
12395 "misc-mail")))
12396@end lisp
12397
12398How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
12399messages in one file per month:
12400
12401@lisp
12402(setq gnus-message-archive-group
12403 '((if (message-news-p)
12404 "misc-news"
12405 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
12406@end lisp
12407
12408@c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
12409@c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
12410
12411Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
12412group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
12413you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
12414archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
12415Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
12416enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
12417group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
12418if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
12419nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
12420continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
12421
12422That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
12423different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
12424case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
12425this will disable archiving.
12426
12427@table @code
12428@item gnus-outgoing-message-group
12429@vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
12430All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
12431all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
12432you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
12433group names.
12434
12435If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
12436message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
12437current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
12438of names).
12439
12440This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
12441but the latter is the preferred method.
12442
12443@item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12444@vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12445If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
12446
12447@item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12448@vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12449If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
12450and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
12451@code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
12452non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
12453changed in the future.
12454
12455@end table
12456
12457
12458@node Posting Styles
12459@section Posting Styles
12460@cindex posting styles
12461@cindex styles
12462
12463All them variables, they make my head swim.
12464
12465So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
12466on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
12467and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
12468on?
12469
12470@vindex gnus-posting-styles
12471One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
12472variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
12473came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
12474a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
12475variable:
12476
12477@lisp
12478((".*"
12479 (signature "Peace and happiness")
12480 (organization "What me?"))
12481 ("^comp"
12482 (signature "Death to everybody"))
12483 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
12484 (organization "Emacs is it")))
12485@end lisp
12486
12487As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
12488@dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
12489``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
12490over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
12491applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
12492the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
12493@samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
12494signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
12495
12496The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
12497string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
12498If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
12499will look in the original article for a header whose name is
12500@var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
12501@var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
12502replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
12503followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
12504@code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
12505no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
12506referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
12507any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
12508said to @dfn{match}.
12509
12510Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
12511attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
12512addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
12513form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
12514@code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
12515contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
12516@var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
12517name can be one of:
12518
12519@itemize @bullet
12520@item @code{signature}
12521@item @code{signature-file}
12522@item @code{x-face-file}
12523@item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
12524@item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
12525@item @code{body}
12526@end itemize
12527
01c52d31
MB
12528Note that the @code{signature-file} attribute honors the variable
12529@code{message-signature-directory}.
12530
4009494e
GM
12531The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
12532this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
12533the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
12534name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
12535is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
12536
12537The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
12538zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
12539will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
12540will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
12541message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
12542are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
12543is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
12544references chars lines xref extra.
12545
12546@vindex message-reply-headers
12547
12548If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
12549meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
12550of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
12551
12552@findex message-mail-p
12553@findex message-news-p
12554
12555So here's a new example:
12556
12557@lisp
12558(setq gnus-posting-styles
12559 '((".*"
12560 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12561 (name "User Name")
12562 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12563 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12564 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12565 ("^rec.humor"
12566 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12567 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12568 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12569 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12570 (signature my-news-signature))
12571 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12572 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12573 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12574 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12575 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12576 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12577 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12578 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12579 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
12580 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12581 ("nnml:.*"
12582 (From (save-excursion
12583 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
12584 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12585 ("^nn.+:"
12586 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12587@end lisp
12588
12589The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12590@code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12591if you fill many roles.
12592You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12593@xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
12594
12595@node Drafts
12596@section Drafts
12597@cindex drafts
12598
12599If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12600you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12601craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12602the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12603other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
12604
12605Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12606some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12607automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12608If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12609article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12610group.)
12611
12612@cindex nndraft
12613@vindex nndraft-directory
12614The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12615@code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12616@samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12617@code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12618that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12619read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
12620
12621If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12622to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12623unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12624a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12625behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12626be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12627simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12628Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12629correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
12630
12631@c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12632@c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12633@c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12634@c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12635@c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12636@c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12637@c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12638@c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12639@c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12640@c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12641@c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12642@c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12643@c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12644@c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12645@c
12646@c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12647@c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12648@c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12649
12650@findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12651@kindex D e (Draft)
12652When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12653draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12654that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12655
12656Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12657Articles}).
12658
12659@findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12660@kindex D s (Draft)
12661@findex gnus-draft-send-message
12662@kindex D S (Draft)
12663If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12664doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12665(@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12666process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12667command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12668in the buffer.
12669
12670@findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12671@kindex D t (Draft)
12672If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12673@kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12674as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12675
12676
12677@node Rejected Articles
12678@section Rejected Articles
12679@cindex rejected articles
12680
12681Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12682doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12683@emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12684Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12685
12686These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12687(Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12688fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12689you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12690articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12691
12692The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12693(@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12694typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12695
12696@node Signing and encrypting
12697@section Signing and encrypting
12698@cindex using gpg
12699@cindex using s/mime
12700@cindex using smime
12701
12702Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12703@acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12704decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12705@code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12706
12707@vindex gnus-message-replysign
12708@vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12709@vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12710Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12711messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12712are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12713@code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12714@code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12715@code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12716automatically encrypted messages.
12717
12718Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12719@acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12720signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12721
12722@table @kbd
12723
12724@item C-c C-m s s
12725@kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12726@findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12727
12728Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12729
12730@item C-c C-m s o
12731@kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12732@findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12733
12734Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12735
12736@item C-c C-m s p
12737@kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12738@findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12739
12740Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12741
12742@item C-c C-m c s
12743@kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12744@findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12745
12746Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12747
12748@item C-c C-m c o
12749@kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
12750@findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
12751
12752Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12753
12754@item C-c C-m c p
12755@kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
12756@findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
12757
12758Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12759
12760@item C-c C-m C-n
12761@kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
12762@findex mml-unsecure-message
12763Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
12764
12765@end table
12766
12767@xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
12768
12769@node Select Methods
12770@chapter Select Methods
12771@cindex foreign groups
12772@cindex select methods
12773
12774A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
12775default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
12776@acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
12777personal mail group.
12778
12779A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
12780a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
12781list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
12782@code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
12783name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
12784value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
12785
12786One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
12787we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
12788
12789The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
12790group as.
12791
12792For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
12793@samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
12794method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
12795@samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
12796back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
12797
12798The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
12799
12800@menu
12801* Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
12802* Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
12803* Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
12804* Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
12805* IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
12806* Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
12807* Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
12808* Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
12809* Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
12810@end menu
12811
12812
12813@node Server Buffer
12814@section Server Buffer
12815
12816Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
12817one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
12818connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
12819one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
12820the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
12821back end represents a virtual server.
12822
12823For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
12824different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
12825on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
12826use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
12827
12828These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
12829complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
12830@acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
12831hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
12832Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
12833server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
12834select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
12835
12836To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
12837(@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
12838
12839@menu
12840* Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
12841* Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
12842* Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
12843* Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
12844* Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
12845* Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
12846* Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
12847@end menu
12848
12849@vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
12850@code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
12851
12852
12853@node Server Buffer Format
12854@subsection Server Buffer Format
12855@cindex server buffer format
12856
12857@vindex gnus-server-line-format
12858You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
12859@code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
12860variable, with some simple extensions:
12861
12862@table @samp
12863
12864@item h
12865How the news is fetched---the back end name.
12866
12867@item n
12868The name of this server.
12869
12870@item w
12871Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
12872
12873@item s
12874The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
12875
12876@item a
12877Whether this server is agentized.
12878@end table
12879
12880@vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
12881The mode line can also be customized by using the
12882@code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
12883Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
12884
12885@table @samp
12886@item S
12887Server name.
12888
12889@item M
12890Server method.
12891@end table
12892
12893Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
12894
12895
12896@node Server Commands
12897@subsection Server Commands
12898@cindex server commands
12899
12900@table @kbd
12901
12902@item v
12903@kindex v (Server)
12904@cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
12905The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12906command or better use it as a prefix key.
12907
12908@item a
12909@kindex a (Server)
12910@findex gnus-server-add-server
12911Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
12912
12913@item e
12914@kindex e (Server)
12915@findex gnus-server-edit-server
12916Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
12917
12918@item SPACE
12919@kindex SPACE (Server)
12920@findex gnus-server-read-server
12921Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
12922
12923@item q
12924@kindex q (Server)
12925@findex gnus-server-exit
12926Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
12927
12928@item k
12929@kindex k (Server)
12930@findex gnus-server-kill-server
12931Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
12932
12933@item y
12934@kindex y (Server)
12935@findex gnus-server-yank-server
12936Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
12937
12938@item c
12939@kindex c (Server)
12940@findex gnus-server-copy-server
12941Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
12942
12943@item l
12944@kindex l (Server)
12945@findex gnus-server-list-servers
12946List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
12947
12948@item s
12949@kindex s (Server)
12950@findex gnus-server-scan-server
12951Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
12952(@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
12953servers.
12954
12955@item g
12956@kindex g (Server)
12957@findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
12958Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
12959(@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
12960a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
12961
01c52d31
MB
12962@item z
12963@kindex z (Server)
12964@findex gnus-server-compact-server
12965
12966Compact all groups in the server under point
12967(@code{gnus-server-compact-server}). Currently implemented only in
12968nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes gaps between article numbers,
12969hence getting a correct total article count.
12970
4009494e
GM
12971@end table
12972
12973
12974@node Example Methods
12975@subsection Example Methods
12976
12977Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
12978
12979@lisp
12980(nntp "news.funet.fi")
12981@end lisp
12982
12983Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
12984
12985@lisp
12986(nnspool "")
12987@end lisp
12988
12989As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
12990back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
12991will.
12992
12993After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
12994@code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
12995
12996To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
12997port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
12998look like then:
12999
13000@lisp
13001(nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
13002@end lisp
13003
13004You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
13005variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
13006
13007@code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
13008you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
13009mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
13010your private mail:
13011
13012@lisp
13013(nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
13014@end lisp
13015
13016(This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
13017that.)
13018
13019Here's the method for a public spool:
13020
13021@lisp
13022(nnmh "public"
13023 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
13024 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
13025@end lisp
13026
13027@cindex proxy
13028@cindex firewall
13029
13030If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
13031server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
13032on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13033Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
13034should probably look something like this:
13035
13036@lisp
13037(nntp "firewall"
13038 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
13039 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
13040 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host")
13041 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
13042@end lisp
13043
13044If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
13045compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
13046configuration to the example above:
13047
13048@lisp
13049 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13050@end lisp
13051
01c52d31
MB
13052See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}. Here's an example for
13053an indirect connection:
13054@lisp
13055(setq gnus-select-method
13056 '(nntp "indirect"
13057 (nntp-address "news.server.example")
13058 (nntp-via-user-name "intermediate_user_name")
13059 (nntp-via-address "intermediate.host.example")
13060 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13061 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
13062 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches ("-C" "-t" "-e" "none"))
13063 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)))
13064@end lisp
4009494e
GM
13065
13066If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
13067through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
13068telnet connection to the news server as follows:
13069
13070@lisp
13071(nntp "outside"
13072 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13073 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-telnet)
13074 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
13075 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
13076@end lisp
13077
13078This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
13079provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
13080connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
13081@code{ssh} @file{config} file.
13082
13083
13084@node Creating a Virtual Server
13085@subsection Creating a Virtual Server
13086
13087If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
13088articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
13089
13090First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
13091would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
13092could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
13093
13094Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
13095
13096You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
13097@samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
13098Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
13099will contain the following:
13100
13101@lisp
13102(nnml "cache")
13103@end lisp
13104
13105Change that to:
13106
13107@lisp
13108(nnml "cache"
13109 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
13110 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
13111@end lisp
13112
13113Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
13114@kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
13115buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
13116
13117
13118@node Server Variables
13119@subsection Server Variables
13120@cindex server variables
13121@cindex server parameters
13122
13123One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
13124in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
13125variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
13126change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
13127won't change the ``derived'' variables.
13128
13129This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
13130@code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
13131directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
13132@code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
13133new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
13134@code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
13135variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
13136variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
13137manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
13138
13139@lisp
13140(nnml "public"
13141 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
13142 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
13143 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
13144@end lisp
13145
13146Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
13147
13148@node Servers and Methods
13149@subsection Servers and Methods
13150
13151Wherever you would normally use a select method
13152(e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
13153when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
13154instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
13155over.
13156
13157
13158@node Unavailable Servers
13159@subsection Unavailable Servers
13160
13161If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
13162@code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
13163with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
13164will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
13165actually the case or not.
13166
13167That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
13168Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
13169@samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
13170away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
13171to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
13172attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
13173attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
13174it will regard that server as ``down''.
13175
13176So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
13177How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
13178
13179You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
13180with the following commands:
13181
13182@table @kbd
13183
13184@item O
13185@kindex O (Server)
13186@findex gnus-server-open-server
13187Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
13188(@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
13189
13190@item C
13191@kindex C (Server)
13192@findex gnus-server-close-server
13193Close the connection (if any) to the server
13194(@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
13195
13196@item D
13197@kindex D (Server)
13198@findex gnus-server-deny-server
13199Mark the current server as unreachable
13200(@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
13201
13202@item M-o
13203@kindex M-o (Server)
13204@findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
13205Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
13206(@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
13207
13208@item M-c
13209@kindex M-c (Server)
13210@findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
13211Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
13212(@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
13213
13214@item R
13215@kindex R (Server)
13216@findex gnus-server-remove-denials
13217Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
13218(@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
13219
13220@item L
13221@kindex L (Server)
13222@findex gnus-server-offline-server
13223Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
13224
13225@end table
13226
13227
13228@node Getting News
13229@section Getting News
13230@cindex reading news
13231@cindex news back ends
13232
13233A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
13234only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
13235or it can read from a local spool.
13236
13237@menu
13238* NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13239* News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
13240@end menu
13241
13242
13243@node NNTP
13244@subsection NNTP
13245@cindex nntp
13246
13247Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
13248You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
13249server as the, uhm, address.
13250
13251If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
13252third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
13253to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
13254that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
13255
13256The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
13257fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
13258you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
13259
13260The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
13261server:
13262
13263@table @code
13264
13265@item nntp-server-opened-hook
13266@vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
13267@cindex @sc{mode reader}
13268@cindex authinfo
13269@cindex authentication
13270@cindex nntp authentication
13271@findex nntp-send-authinfo
13272@findex nntp-send-mode-reader
13273is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
13274commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
13275default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
13276@code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
13277present in this hook.
13278
13279@item nntp-authinfo-function
13280@vindex nntp-authinfo-function
13281@findex nntp-send-authinfo
13282@vindex nntp-authinfo-file
13283This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
13284server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
13285through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
13286@code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
13287are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
13288format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
13289@code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
13290manual page, but here are the salient facts:
13291
13292@enumerate
13293@item
13294The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
13295
13296@item
13297Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
13298
13299The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
13300@samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
13301in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
13302@samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
13303deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
13304indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
13305@samp{force} is explained below.
13306
13307@end enumerate
13308
13309Here's an example file:
13310
13311@example
13312machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
13313machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
13314@end example
13315
13316The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
13317have to be first, for instance.
13318
13319In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
13320former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
13321user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
13322@samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
13323@var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
13324@samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
13325until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
13326
13327You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
13328that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
13329
13330@example
13331default force yes
13332@end example
13333
13334This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
13335previously mentioned.
13336
13337Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
13338
13339@item nntp-server-action-alist
13340@vindex nntp-server-action-alist
13341This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
13342taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
13343every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
13344
13345@lisp
13346(setq nntp-server-action-alist
13347 '(("innd" (ding))))
13348@end lisp
13349
13350You probably don't want to do that, though.
13351
13352The default value is
13353
13354@lisp
13355'(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
13356 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
13357 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
13358@end lisp
13359
13360This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
13361nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
13362
13363@item nntp-maximum-request
13364@vindex nntp-maximum-request
13365If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
13366will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
13367speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
13368waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
13369by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
13370your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
13371
13372@item nntp-connection-timeout
13373@vindex nntp-connection-timeout
13374If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
13375regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
13376responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
13377time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
13378somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
13379that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
13380connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
13381no timeouts are done.
13382
13383@item nntp-nov-is-evil
13384@vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
13385If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
13386variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
13387can be used.
13388
13389@item nntp-xover-commands
13390@vindex nntp-xover-commands
13391@cindex @acronym{NOV}
13392@cindex XOVER
13393List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
13394server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
13395"XOVERVIEW")}.
13396
13397@item nntp-nov-gap
13398@vindex nntp-nov-gap
13399@code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
13400the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
13401if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
13402article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
13403lines that you will not need. This variable says how
13404big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
13405@code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
13406network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
13407that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
13408@code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
13409
13410@item nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13411@vindex nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13412When Gnus refers to an article having the @code{Message-ID} that a user
13413specifies or having the @code{Message-ID} of the parent article of the
13414current one (@pxref{Finding the Parent}), Gnus sends a @code{HEAD}
13415command to the @acronym{NNTP} server to know where it is, and the server
13416returns the data containing the pairs of a group and an article number
13417in the @code{Xref} header. Gnus normally uses the article number to
13418refer to the article if the data shows that that article is in the
13419current group, while it uses the @code{Message-ID} otherwise. However,
13420some news servers, e.g., ones running Diablo, run multiple engines
13421having the same articles but article numbers are not kept synchronized
13422between them. In that case, the article number that appears in the
13423@code{Xref} header varies by which engine is chosen, so you cannot refer
13424to the parent article that is in the current group, for instance. If
13425you connect to such a server, set this variable to a non-@code{nil}
13426value, and Gnus never uses article numbers. For example:
13427
13428@lisp
13429(setq gnus-select-method
13430 '(nntp "newszilla"
13431 (nntp-address "newszilla.example.com")
13432 (nntp-xref-number-is-evil t)
13433 @dots{}))
13434@end lisp
13435
13436The default value of this server variable is @code{nil}.
13437
13438@item nntp-prepare-server-hook
13439@vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
13440A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13441
13442@item nntp-record-commands
13443@vindex nntp-record-commands
13444If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
13445@acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
13446buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
13447that doesn't seem to work.
13448
13449@item nntp-open-connection-function
13450@vindex nntp-open-connection-function
13451It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
13452be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
13453parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
01c52d31
MB
13454Seven pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped
13455in two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
13456indirect ones (three pre-made).
4009494e
GM
13457
13458@item nntp-never-echoes-commands
13459@vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
13460Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
13461reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
13462to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
13463@code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
13464example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
13465@code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
13466overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
13467
13468@item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13469@vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13470List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
13471you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
13472not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
13473@code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
13474default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
13475
13476@item nntp-prepare-post-hook
13477@vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
13478A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
13479@code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
13480recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
13481hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
13482inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
13483
13484@lisp
13485(add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
13486@end lisp
13487
13488Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
13489INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
13490
13491@end table
13492
13493@menu
13494* Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
13495* Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
13496* Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
01c52d31 13497* NNTP marks:: Storing marks for @acronym{NNTP} servers.
4009494e
GM
13498@end menu
13499
13500
13501@node Direct Functions
13502@subsubsection Direct Functions
13503@cindex direct connection functions
13504
13505These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
13506between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
13507functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
13508(@pxref{Common Variables}).
13509
13510@table @code
13511@findex nntp-open-network-stream
13512@item nntp-open-network-stream
13513This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
13514remote system.
13515
13516@findex nntp-open-tls-stream
13517@item nntp-open-tls-stream
13518Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13519this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GNUTLS}
13520installed. You then define a server as follows:
13521
13522@lisp
13523;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13524;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
13525;;
13526(nntp "snews.bar.com"
13527 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
13528 (nntp-port-number )
13529 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13530@end lisp
13531
13532@findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
13533@item nntp-open-ssl-stream
13534Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13535this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
13536@uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
13537then define a server as follows:
13538
13539@lisp
13540;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13541;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
13542;;
13543(nntp "snews.bar.com"
13544 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
13545 (nntp-port-number 563)
13546 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13547@end lisp
13548
13549@findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
13550@item nntp-open-telnet-stream
13551Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server by simply @samp{telnet}'ing
13552it. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have the
13553default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
13554of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
13555connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
13556@code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
13557
13558@lisp
13559(nntp "socksified"
13560 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13561 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
13562 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13563@end lisp
13564
13565With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
13566session, which is not a good idea.
13567@end table
13568
13569
13570@node Indirect Functions
13571@subsubsection Indirect Functions
13572@cindex indirect connection functions
13573
13574These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
13575intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13576All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
13577the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
13578things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
13579commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13580
13581@table @code
13582@item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13583@findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13584Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet}
13585to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
13586you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
13587
13588@code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13589
13590@table @code
13591@item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13592@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13593Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13594@samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13595
13596@item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13597@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13598List of strings to be used as the switches to
13599@code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
13600@samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
13601@samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections, otherwise set
13602this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
13603the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
13604host.
13605@end table
13606
01c52d31
MB
13607Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13608to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13609
13610@item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13611@findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13612Does essentially the same, but uses
13613@uref{http://netcat.sourceforge.net/, netcat} instead of @samp{telnet}
13614to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the intermediate host.
13615
13616@code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat}-specific variables:
13617
13618@table @code
13619@item nntp-via-netcat-command
13620@vindex nntp-via-netcat-command
13621Command used to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the
13622intermediate host. The default is @samp{nc}. You can also use other
13623programs like @uref{http://www.imasy.or.jp/~gotoh/ssh/connect.html,
13624connect} instead.
13625
13626@item nntp-via-netcat-switches
13627@vindex nntp-via-netcat-switches
13628List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13629@code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @code{nil}.
13630
13631@item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13632@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13633Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13634@samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13635
13636@item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13637@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13638List of strings to be used as the switches to
13639@code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}.
13640@end table
13641
4009494e
GM
13642@item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13643@findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13644Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
13645@samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
13646
13647@code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13648
13649@table @code
13650@item nntp-via-telnet-command
13651@vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
13652Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
13653@samp{telnet}.
13654
13655@item nntp-via-telnet-switches
13656@vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
13657List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13658@code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
13659
13660@item nntp-via-user-password
13661@vindex nntp-via-user-password
13662Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
13663
13664@item nntp-via-envuser
13665@vindex nntp-via-envuser
13666If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
13667server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
13668login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
13669
13670@item nntp-via-shell-prompt
13671@vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
13672Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
13673is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
13674
13675@end table
13676
01c52d31
MB
13677Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13678to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
4009494e
GM
13679@end table
13680
13681
13682Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
13683functions:
13684
13685@table @code
13686
13687@item nntp-via-user-name
13688@vindex nntp-via-user-name
13689User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
13690
13691@item nntp-via-address
13692@vindex nntp-via-address
13693Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
13694
13695@end table
13696
13697
13698@node Common Variables
13699@subsubsection Common Variables
13700
13701The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
13702pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
13703affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
13704default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
13705variables individually).
13706
13707@table @code
13708
13709@item nntp-pre-command
13710@vindex nntp-pre-command
13711A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
13712connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
13713@code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
13714where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
13715
13716@item nntp-address
13717@vindex nntp-address
13718The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13719
13720@item nntp-port-number
13721@vindex nntp-port-number
13722Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
13723@samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
13724@acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
13725than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
13726@samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
13727not work with named ports.
13728
13729@item nntp-end-of-line
13730@vindex nntp-end-of-line
13731String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
13732server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
01c52d31 13733using a non native telnet connection function.
4009494e
GM
13734
13735@item nntp-telnet-command
13736@vindex nntp-telnet-command
13737Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
13738@samp{telnet}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
13739just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
13740@samp{telnet}.
13741
13742@item nntp-telnet-switches
13743@vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13744A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-telnet-command}. The default
13745is @samp{("-8")}.
13746
13747@end table
13748
01c52d31
MB
13749@node NNTP marks
13750@subsubsection NNTP marks
13751@cindex storing NNTP marks
13752
13753Gnus stores marks (@pxref{Marking Articles}) for @acronym{NNTP}
13754servers in marks files. A marks file records what marks you have set
13755in a group and each file is specific to the corresponding server.
13756Marks files are stored in @file{~/News/marks}
13757(@code{nntp-marks-directory}) under a classic hierarchy resembling
13758that of a news server, for example marks for the group
13759@samp{gmane.discuss} on the news.gmane.org server will be stored in
13760the file @file{~/News/marks/news.gmane.org/gmane/discuss/.marks}.
13761
13762Marks files are useful because you can copy the @file{~/News/marks}
13763directory (using rsync, scp or whatever) to another Gnus installation,
13764and it will realize what articles you have read and marked. The data
13765in @file{~/News/marks} has priority over the same data in
13766@file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
13767
13768Note that marks files are very much server-specific: Gnus remembers
13769the article numbers so if you don't use the same servers on both
13770installations things are most likely to break (most @acronym{NNTP}
13771servers do not use the same article numbers as any other server).
13772However, if you use servers A, B, C on one installation and servers A,
13773D, E on the other, you can sync the marks files for A and then you'll
13774get synchronization for that server between the two installations.
13775
13776Using @acronym{NNTP} marks can possibly incur a performance penalty so
13777if Gnus feels sluggish, try setting the @code{nntp-marks-is-evil}
13778variable to @code{t}. Marks will then be stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
13779
13780Related variables:
13781
13782@table @code
13783
13784@item nntp-marks-is-evil
13785@vindex nntp-marks-is-evil
13786If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any marks files. The
13787default is @code{nil}.
13788
13789@item nntp-marks-directory
13790@vindex nntp-marks-directory
13791The directory where marks for nntp groups will be stored.
13792
13793@end table
13794
4009494e
GM
13795
13796@node News Spool
13797@subsection News Spool
13798@cindex nnspool
13799@cindex news spool
13800
13801Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
13802and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
13803contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
13804instance.
13805
13806Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
13807anything else) as the address.
13808
13809If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
13810native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
13811than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
13812You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
13813
13814@table @code
13815
13816@item nnspool-inews-program
13817@vindex nnspool-inews-program
13818Program used to post an article.
13819
13820@item nnspool-inews-switches
13821@vindex nnspool-inews-switches
13822Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
13823
13824@item nnspool-spool-directory
13825@vindex nnspool-spool-directory
13826Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
13827@file{/usr/spool/news/}.
13828
13829@item nnspool-nov-directory
13830@vindex nnspool-nov-directory
13831Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
13832@file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
13833
13834@item nnspool-lib-dir
13835@vindex nnspool-lib-dir
13836Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
13837
13838@item nnspool-active-file
13839@vindex nnspool-active-file
13840The name of the active file.
13841
13842@item nnspool-newsgroups-file
13843@vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
13844The name of the group descriptions file.
13845
13846@item nnspool-history-file
13847@vindex nnspool-history-file
13848The name of the news history file.
13849
13850@item nnspool-active-times-file
13851@vindex nnspool-active-times-file
13852The name of the active date file.
13853
13854@item nnspool-nov-is-evil
13855@vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
13856If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
13857that it finds.
13858
13859@item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13860@vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13861@cindex sed
13862If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
13863relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
13864@code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
13865there.
13866
13867@end table
13868
13869
13870@node Getting Mail
13871@section Getting Mail
13872@cindex reading mail
13873@cindex mail
13874
13875Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
13876course.
13877
13878@menu
13879* Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
13880* Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
13881* Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
13882* Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
13883* Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
13884* Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
13885* Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
13886* Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
13887* Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
13888* Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
13889* Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
13890* Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
13891* Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
13892@end menu
13893
13894
13895@node Mail in a Newsreader
13896@subsection Mail in a Newsreader
13897
13898If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
13899to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
13900of a culture shock.
13901
13902Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
13903it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
13904
13905Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
13906approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
13907messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
13908you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
13909
13910In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
13911
13912Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
13913deleted? How awful!
13914
13915But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
13916scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
13917the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
13918you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
13919Mail}.
13920
13921What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
13922mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
13923they want to treat a message.
13924
13925Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
13926via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
13927answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
13928need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
13929archived somewhere else.
13930
13931Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
13932These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
13933to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
13934order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
13935to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
13936
13937The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
13938but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
13939or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
13940
13941Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
13942like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
13943differently.
13944
13945Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
13946that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
13947to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
13948not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
13949instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
13950
13951I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
13952may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
13953you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
13954guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
13955Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
13956Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
13957You Do.)
13958
13959
13960@node Getting Started Reading Mail
13961@subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
13962
13963It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
13964mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
13965and things will happen automatically.
13966
13967For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
13968mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
13969
13970@lisp
13971(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
13972@end lisp
13973
13974Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
13975articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
13976directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
13977be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
13978like any other group.
13979
13980You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
13981
13982@lisp
13983(setq nnmail-split-methods
13984 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13985 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13986 ("other" "")))
13987@end lisp
13988
13989This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
13990@samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
13991mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
13992last group.
13993
13994This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
13995give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
13996Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
13997
13998
13999@node Splitting Mail
14000@subsection Splitting Mail
14001@cindex splitting mail
14002@cindex mail splitting
14003@cindex mail filtering (splitting)
14004
14005@vindex nnmail-split-methods
14006The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
14007to be split into groups.
14008
14009@lisp
14010(setq nnmail-split-methods
14011 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14012 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14013 ("mail.other" "")))
14014@end lisp
14015
14016This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
14017these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
14018something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
14019element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
14020determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
14021contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
14022insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
14023
14024@lisp
14025("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
14026@end lisp
14027
14028@noindent
14029In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
14030the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14031
14032The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
14033called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
14034argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
14035mail belongs in that group.
14036
14037@cindex @samp{bogus} group
14038The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
14039expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
14040that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
14041processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
14042to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
14043that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
14044will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
14045splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
14046see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
14047
14048If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
14049function of your choice. This function will be called without any
14050arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
14051message. The function should return a list of group names that it
14052thinks should carry this mail message.
14053
14054Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
14055incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
14056some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
14057@code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
14058
14059@vindex nnmail-crosspost
14060The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
14061the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
14062@code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
14063that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
14064
14065@vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
14066@cindex crosspost
14067@cindex links
14068@code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
14069the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
14070links. If that's the case for you, set
14071@code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
14072variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
14073
14074@kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
14075@findex nnmail-split-history
14076If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
14077can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
14078where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
14079@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
14080Group Commands}).
14081
14082@vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
14083Header lines longer than the value of
14084@code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
14085function.
14086
14087@vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
14088@vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
14089By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
14090non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
14091articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
14092@code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
14093In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
14094variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
14095@code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
14096value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
14097string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
14098charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
14099
14100@vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14101By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
14102specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
14103(@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
14104@emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
14105@code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
14106splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
14107other kinds of entries.)
14108
14109Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
14110yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
14111all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
14112unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
14113boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
14114that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
14115come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
14116you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
14117month's rent money.
14118
14119
14120@node Mail Sources
14121@subsection Mail Sources
14122
14123Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
14124a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
14125maildir, for instance.
14126
14127@menu
14128* Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
14129* Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
14130* Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
14131@end menu
14132
14133
14134@node Mail Source Specifiers
14135@subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
14136@cindex POP
14137@cindex mail server
14138@cindex procmail
14139@cindex mail spool
14140@cindex mail source
14141
14142You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
14143(@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
14144
14145Here's an example:
14146
14147@lisp
14148(pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
14149@end lisp
14150
14151As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
14152element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
14153@dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
14154default values.
14155
14156The following mail source types are available:
14157
14158@table @code
14159@item file
14160Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
14161
14162Keywords:
14163
14164@table @code
14165@item :path
14166The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
14167environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
14168(usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
14169
14170@item :prescript
14171@itemx :postscript
14172Script run before/after fetching mail.
14173@end table
14174
14175An example file mail source:
14176
14177@lisp
14178(file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
14179@end lisp
14180
14181Or using the default file name:
14182
14183@lisp
14184(file)
14185@end lisp
14186
14187If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
14188to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
14189You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
14190mail spool while moving the mail.
14191
14192If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
14193
14194@lisp
14195(setq mail-sources
14196 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
14197@end lisp
14198
14199The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
14200
14201@example
14202#!/bin/sh
14203# getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
14204# flu@@iki.fi
14205
14206MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
14207TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
14208rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
14209@end example
14210
14211Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
14212file you want to use.
14213
14214
14215@item directory
14216@vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
14217Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
14218when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
14219That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
14220directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
14221will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
14222to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
14223@code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
14224Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
14225if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
14226
14227@vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14228There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
14229that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
14230applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
14231
14232Keywords:
14233
14234@table @code
14235@item :path
14236The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
14237value.
14238
14239@item :suffix
14240Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
14241@samp{.spool}.
14242
14243@item :predicate
14244Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
14245The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
14246filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
14247predicate are considered.
14248
14249@item :prescript
14250@itemx :postscript
14251Script run before/after fetching mail.
14252
14253@end table
14254
14255An example directory mail source:
14256
14257@lisp
14258(directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
14259 :suffix ".prcml")
14260@end lisp
14261
14262@item pop
14263Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14264
14265Keywords:
14266
14267@table @code
14268@item :server
14269The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
14270@env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14271
14272@item :port
14273The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
14274@samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
14275string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
14276Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
14277need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
14278
14279@item :user
14280The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
14281name.
14282
14283@item :password
14284The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
14285the user is prompted.
14286
14287@item :program
14288The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
14289should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
14290
14291@example
14292fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
14293@end example
14294
14295The valid format specifier characters are:
14296
14297@table @samp
14298@item t
14299The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
14300included in this string.
14301
14302@item s
14303The name of the server.
14304
14305@item P
14306The port number of the server.
14307
14308@item u
14309The user name to use.
14310
14311@item p
14312The password to use.
14313@end table
14314
14315The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14316corresponding keywords.
14317
14318@item :prescript
14319A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14320the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14321
14322@item :postscript
14323A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14324the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14325
14326@item :function
14327The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
14328function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
14329mail should be moved to.
14330
14331@item :authentication
14332This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
14333and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
14334@code{password}.
14335
14336@end table
14337
14338@vindex pop3-movemail
14339@vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
14340If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
14341@code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server}
14342is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
14343after fetching when using @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers
14344maintain no state information between sessions, so what the client
14345believes is there and what is actually there may not match up. If they
14346do not, then you may get duplicate mails or the whole thing can fall
14347apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
14348
14349Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14350Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
14351name, and default fetcher:
14352
14353@lisp
14354(pop)
14355@end lisp
14356
14357Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
14358
14359@lisp
14360(pop :server "my.pop.server"
14361 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
14362@end lisp
14363
14364Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
14365
14366@lisp
14367(pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
14368@end lisp
14369
14370@item maildir
14371Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
14372at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
14373contains exactly one mail.
14374
14375Keywords:
14376
14377@table @code
14378@item :path
14379The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
14380taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
14381@file{~/Maildir/}.
14382@item :subdirs
14383The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
14384@samp{("new" "cur")}.
14385
14386@c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
14387@c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
14388@c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
14389@c below.
14390
14391You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
14392from locking problems).
14393
14394@end table
14395
14396Two example maildir mail sources:
14397
14398@lisp
14399(maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
14400 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
14401@end lisp
14402
14403@lisp
14404(maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
14405 :subdirs ("new"))
14406@end lisp
14407
14408@item imap
14409Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
14410@acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
14411with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
14412to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
14413@acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for more information.
14414
14415Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} and STARTTLS support you
14416may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
14417
14418Keywords:
14419
14420@table @code
14421@item :server
14422The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
14423@env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14424
14425@item :port
14426The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
14427@samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14428
14429@item :user
14430The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
14431name.
14432
14433@item :password
14434The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
14435prompted.
14436
14437@item :stream
14438What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
14439symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
14440@samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
14441@samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
14442
14443@item :authentication
14444Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
14445one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
14446this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
14447@samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
14448
14449@item :program
14450When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
14451mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
14452@code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
14453
14454@example
14455ssh %s imapd
14456@end example
14457
01c52d31
MB
14458Make sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g.,
14459don't forget to redirect the error output to the void. The valid format
14460specifier characters are:
4009494e
GM
14461
14462@table @samp
14463@item s
14464The name of the server.
14465
14466@item l
14467User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
14468
14469@item p
14470The port number of the server.
14471@end table
14472
14473The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14474corresponding keywords.
14475
14476@item :mailbox
14477The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
14478which normally is the mailbox which receive incoming mail.
14479
14480@item :predicate
14481The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
14482UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
14483sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
14484articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
14485Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
14486complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
14487
14488@item :fetchflag
14489How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
14490will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
14491would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
14492but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
14493
14494@item :dontexpunge
14495If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
14496mailbox after finishing the fetch.
14497
14498@end table
14499
14500An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
14501
14502@lisp
14503(imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
14504 :stream kerberos4
14505 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
14506@end lisp
14507
14508@item webmail
14509Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{http://www.hotmail.com/},
14510@uref{http://webmail.netscape.com/}, @uref{http://www.netaddress.com/},
14511@uref{http://mail.yahoo.com/}.
14512
14513NOTE: Webmail largely depends on cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
14514required for url "4.0pre.46".
14515
14516WARNING: Mails may be lost. NO WARRANTY.
14517
14518Keywords:
14519
14520@table @code
14521@item :subtype
14522The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
14523alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
14524
14525@item :user
14526The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
14527name.
14528
14529@item :password
14530The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
14531prompted.
14532
14533@item :dontexpunge
14534If non-@code{nil}, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to
14535trash folder after finishing the fetch.
14536
14537@end table
14538
14539An example webmail source:
14540
14541@lisp
14542(webmail :subtype 'hotmail
14543 :user "user-name"
14544 :password "secret")
14545@end lisp
14546@end table
14547
14548@table @dfn
14549@item Common Keywords
14550Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
14551
14552Keywords:
14553
14554@table @code
14555@item :plugged
14556If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
14557use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
14558example:
14559
14560@lisp
14561(setq mail-sources
14562 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
14563 :suffix ""
14564 :plugged t)))
14565@end lisp
14566
14567Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
14568useful when you use local mail and news.
14569
14570@end table
14571@end table
14572
14573@subsubsection Function Interface
14574
14575Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
14576For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
14577the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
14578consider the following mail-source setting:
14579
14580@lisp
14581(setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
14582 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
14583@end lisp
14584
14585While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
14586is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
14587@code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
14588@code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
14589and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
14590
14591See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
14592
14593
14594@node Mail Source Customization
14595@subsubsection Mail Source Customization
14596
14597The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
14598fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
14599variables.
14600
14601@table @code
14602@item mail-source-crash-box
14603@vindex mail-source-crash-box
14604File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
14605@file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
14606
14607@item mail-source-delete-incoming
14608@vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
14609If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
14610@code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
14611files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
14612(This will only happen, when receiving new mail). You may also set
14613@code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
14614@code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
14615
14616@item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
14617@vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
14618If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
14619files. This variable only applies when
14620@code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
14621
14622@item mail-source-ignore-errors
14623@vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
14624If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
14625
14626@item mail-source-directory
14627@vindex mail-source-directory
14628Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
14629default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
14630is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
14631@code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
14632
14633@item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
14634@vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
14635Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
14636@file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
14637@file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
14638relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
14639number.
14640
14641@item mail-source-default-file-modes
14642@vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
14643All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
14644
14645@item mail-source-movemail-program
14646@vindex mail-source-movemail-program
14647If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
14648@code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
14649
14650@end table
14651
14652
14653@node Fetching Mail
14654@subsubsection Fetching Mail
14655
14656@vindex mail-sources
4009494e
GM
14657The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
14658@code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
14659(@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
14660
b890d447
MB
14661If this variable is @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to
14662fetch mail by themselves.
4009494e
GM
14663
14664If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
14665@acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
14666
14667@lisp
14668(setq mail-sources
14669 '((file)
14670 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
14671 :password "secret")))
14672@end lisp
14673
14674Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
14675
14676@lisp
14677(setq mail-sources
14678 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
14679 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
14680 :user "user-name"
14681 :port "pop3"
14682 :password "secret")))
14683@end lisp
14684
14685
14686When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
14687inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
14688mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
14689invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
14690pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
14691shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
14692
14693
14694
14695@node Mail Back End Variables
14696@subsection Mail Back End Variables
14697
14698These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
14699mail back ends.
14700
14701@table @code
14702@vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
14703@item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
14704The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
14705use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
14706
14707@vindex nnmail-split-hook
14708@item nnmail-split-hook
14709@findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
14710@cindex RFC 1522 decoding
14711@cindex RFC 2047 decoding
14712Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
14713just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
14714free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
14715is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
14716in the buffer will show up in any files.
14717@code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
14718to this hook.
14719
14720@vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14721@vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14722@item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14723@itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14724These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
14725mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
14726starting to handle the new mail) and
14727@code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
14728is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
14729default file modes the new mail files get:
14730
14731@lisp
14732(add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14733 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
14734
14735(add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14736 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
14737@end lisp
14738
14739@item nnmail-use-long-file-names
14740@vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
14741If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
14742names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
14743(assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
14744@code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
14745the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
14746
14747@item nnmail-delete-file-function
14748@vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
14749@findex delete-file
14750Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
14751
14752@item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14753@vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14754If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
14755the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
14756discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
14757
14758@item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
14759@vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
14760This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
14761Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
14762recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
14763
14764This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
14765(@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
14766@code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
14767
14768@end table
14769
14770
14771@node Fancy Mail Splitting
14772@subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
14773@cindex mail splitting
14774@cindex fancy mail splitting
14775
14776@vindex nnmail-split-fancy
14777@findex nnmail-split-fancy
14778If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
14779doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
14780@code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
14781play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
14782
14783Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
14784
14785@lisp
14786;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
14787;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
14788;; @r{from real errors.}
14789(| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
14790 "mail.misc"))
14791 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
14792 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
14793 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
14794 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
14795 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
14796 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
14797 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
14798 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
14799 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
14800 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
14801 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
14802 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
14803 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
14804 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
14805 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
14806 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
14807 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
14808 "misc.misc")
14809@end lisp
14810
14811This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
14812(possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
14813splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
14814
14815@table @code
14816
14817@item group
14818If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
14819regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
14820
14821@c Don't fold this line.
14822@item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
14823The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
14824first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
14825@var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
14826@var{split}.
14827
14828If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
14829@var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
14830@var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
14831@var{split} is processed.
14832
14833The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
14834non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
14835variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
14836be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
14837
14838@item (| @var{split} @dots{})
14839If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
14840bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
14841@var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
14842stored in one or more groups.
14843
14844@item (& @var{split} @dots{})
14845If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
14846process all @var{split}s in the list.
14847
14848@item junk
14849If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
14850this message. Use with extreme caution.
14851
14852@item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
14853If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
14854second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
14855arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
14856
14857@cindex body split
14858For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
14859body of the messages:
14860
14861@lisp
14862(defun split-on-body ()
14863 (save-excursion
14864 (save-restriction
14865 (widen)
14866 (goto-char (point-min))
14867 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
14868 "string.group"))))
14869@end lisp
14870
b890d447
MB
14871The buffer is narrowed to the header of the message in question when
14872@var{function} is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called
14873after @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
23f87bed 14874above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
4009494e
GM
14875not be downloaded by default. You need to set
14876@code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
14877(@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
14878
14879@item (! @var{func} @var{split})
14880If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
14881@var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
14882function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
14883should return a split.
14884
14885@item nil
14886If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
14887
14888@end table
14889
14890In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
14891
14892Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
14893according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
14894@var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
14895which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
14896for example,
14897
14898@example
14899(any "joe" "joemail")
14900@end example
14901
14902@noindent
14903messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
14904in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
14905of the following three ways:
14906
14907@enumerate
14908@item
14909@vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
14910You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
14911to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
14912match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
14913words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
14914@code{nil}.
14915
14916Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
14917
14918@item
14919@var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
14920a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
14921in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
14922@code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
14923@code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
14924
14925@item
14926You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
14927@samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
14928section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
14929are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
14930@code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
14931ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
14932non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
14933@end enumerate
14934
14935@vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
14936@var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
14937they are expanded as specified by the variable
14938@code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
14939where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
14940contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
14941@code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
14942
14943@table @code
14944@item from
14945Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
14946@item to
14947Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
14948@samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
14949@item any
14950Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
14951@end table
14952
14953@vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
14954@code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
14955when all this splitting is performed.
14956
14957If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
14958information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
14959substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
14960
14961@example
14962(any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
14963@end example
14964
14965In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
14966will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
14967
14968If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
14969matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
14970up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
14971groupings 1 through 9.
14972
14973@vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
14974Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
14975lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
14976Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
14977groups when users send to an address using different case
14978(i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
14979is @code{t}.
14980
14981@findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
14982@code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
14983split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
14984you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
14985boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
14986working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
14987string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
14988messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
14989it once per thread.
14990
14991To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
14992and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
14993value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
14994using the colon feature, like so:
14995@lisp
14996(setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
14997 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
14998 nnmail-split-fancy
14999 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
15000 ;; @r{other splits go here}
15001 ))
15002@end lisp
15003
15004This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
15005non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
15006in the file specified by the variable
15007@code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
15008(the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
15009invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
15010at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
15011and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
15012for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
15013corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
15014@code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
15015recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
15016somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
15017still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
15018300 kBytes in size.)
15019@vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15020When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
15021also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
15022messages goes into the new group.
15023
15024Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
15025want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
15026outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
15027@code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
15028Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
15029``outgoing'' group.
15030
15031
15032@node Group Mail Splitting
15033@subsection Group Mail Splitting
15034@cindex mail splitting
15035@cindex group mail splitting
15036
15037@findex gnus-group-split
15038If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
15039maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
15040You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
15041parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
15042@code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
15043for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
15044from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
15045@code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
15046
15047Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
15048splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
15049parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
15050rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
15051
15052All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
15053@code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
15054the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
15055@code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
15056matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
15057group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
15058@code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
15059
15060If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
15061parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
15062parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
15063this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
15064@code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
15065@code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
15066@code{gnus-group-split}.
15067
15068@vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
15069@code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
15070by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
15071group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
15072group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
15073some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
15074that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
15075often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
15076complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
15077may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
15078personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
15079element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
15080with the rules extracted from group parameters.
15081
15082It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
15083been defined:
15084
15085@example
15086nnml:mail.bar:
15087((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
15088 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
15089nnml:mail.foo:
15090((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
15091 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
15092 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
15093 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
15094nnml:mail.others:
15095((split-spec . catch-all))
15096@end example
15097
15098Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
15099behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
15100@code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
15101
15102@lisp
15103(| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
15104 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
15105 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
15106 "mail.others")
15107@end lisp
15108
15109@findex gnus-group-split-fancy
15110If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
15111may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
15112splits like this:
15113
15114@lisp
15115(: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
15116@end lisp
15117
15118@var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
15119parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
15120@var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
15121single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
15122fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
15123If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
15124empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
15125Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
15126this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
15127
15128@findex gnus-group-split-setup
15129Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
15130slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
15131But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
15132used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
15133sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
15134@code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
15135@code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
15136scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
15137
15138@findex gnus-group-split-update
15139However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
15140@code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
15141@code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
15142automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
15143you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
15144
15145@lisp
15146(gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
15147@end lisp
15148
15149If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
15150will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
15151have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
15152don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
15153@code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
15154value.
15155
15156@vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
15157Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
15158by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
15159@code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
15160
15161@node Incorporating Old Mail
15162@subsection Incorporating Old Mail
15163@cindex incorporating old mail
15164@cindex import old mail
15165
15166Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
15167you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
15168back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
15169your mail groups.
15170
15171Doing so can be quite easy.
15172
15173To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
15174(@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
15175satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
15176file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
15177your @code{nnml} groups.
15178
15179Here's how:
15180
15181@enumerate
15182@item
15183Go to the group buffer.
15184
15185@item
15186Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
15187@code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15188
15189@item
15190Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
15191
15192@item
15193Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
15194(@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
15195
15196@item
15197Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
15198@samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
15199@end enumerate
15200
15201All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
15202all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
15203have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
15204deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
15205sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
15206
15207Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
15208back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
15209using the new mail back end.
15210
15211
15212@node Expiring Mail
15213@subsection Expiring Mail
15214@cindex article expiry
15215@cindex expiring mail
15216
15217Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
15218you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
15219different approach to mail reading.
15220
15221Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
15222a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
15223actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
15224mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
15225fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
15226Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
15227course.
15228
15229To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
15230articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
15231that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
15232will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
15233deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
15234more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
15235will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
15236repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
15237NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
15238
15239You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
15240two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
15241with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
15242for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
15243considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
15244the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
15245@samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} and so on are considered
15246expirable.
15247
15248When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
15249who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
15250and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
15251(@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
15252into its own group.)
15253
15254Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
15255answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
15256advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
15257the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
15258between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
15259only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
15260total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
15261Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
15262scoring.
15263
15264@vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15265Groups that match the regular expression
15266@code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
15267read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
15268expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
15269
15270By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
15271articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
15272before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
15273automatically, you can put something like the following in your
15274@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15275
15276@vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
15277@lisp
15278(remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
15279 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
15280(add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
15281@end lisp
15282
15283Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
15284articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
15285will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
15286articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
15287mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
15288
15289Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
15290articles you have read to disappear after a while:
15291
15292@lisp
15293(setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15294 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
15295@end lisp
15296
15297Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
15298@code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
15299
15300If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
15301auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
15302don't really mix very well.
15303
15304@vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
15305The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
15306expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
15307message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
15308days.
15309
15310Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
15311are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
15312have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
15313expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
15314everywhere else:
15315
15316@vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15317@lisp
15318(setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15319 (lambda (group)
15320 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
15321 31)
15322 ((string= group "mail.junk")
15323 1)
15324 ((string= group "important")
15325 'never)
15326 (t
15327 6))))
15328@end lisp
15329
15330The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
15331names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
15332
15333The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
15334@code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
15335necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
15336@code{never}.
15337
15338You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
15339change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
15340
15341@vindex nnmail-expiry-target
15342The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
15343However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
15344to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
15345@code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
15346parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
15347all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
15348parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
15349string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
15350moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
15351the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
15352from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
15353name or @code{delete}.
15354
15355Here's an example for specifying a group name:
15356@lisp
15357(setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
15358@end lisp
15359
15360@findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15361@vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15362Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
15363expire mail to groups according to the variable
15364@code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
15365
15366@lisp
15367 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15368 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15369 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
15370 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
15371 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
15372@end lisp
15373
15374With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
15375header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
15376get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
15377From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
15378to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
15379@code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
15380
15381@vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
15382If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
15383expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
15384easier for procmail users.
15385
15386@vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
15387By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
15388articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
15389parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
15390articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
15391caution. Even more dangerous is the
15392@code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
15393this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
15394which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
15395will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
15396crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
15397wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
15398@emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
15399with! So there!
15400
15401Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
15402
15403@vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
15404If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
15405commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
15406auto-expire turned on.
15407
15408
15409@node Washing Mail
15410@subsection Washing Mail
15411@cindex mail washing
15412@cindex list server brain damage
15413@cindex incoming mail treatment
15414
15415Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
15416really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
15417prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
15418end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
15419Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
15420considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
15421
15422Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
15423} to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
15424be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
15425laugh.
15426
15427Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
15428displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
15429storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
15430various functions that can be put in these hooks.
15431
15432@table @code
15433@item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15434@vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15435This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
15436grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
15437the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
15438
15439@table @code
15440@item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15441@findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15442Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
15443Emacs running on MS machines.
15444
15445@end table
15446
15447@item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15448@vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15449This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
15450cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
15451
15452@table @code
15453@item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15454@findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15455Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
15456headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
15457
15458(Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
15459messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
15460of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
15461rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
15462into a feature by documenting it.)
15463
15464@item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15465@findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15466Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
15467beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
15468people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
15469strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
15470also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
15471@code{\\(..\\)}.
15472
15473For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
15474@samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
15475
15476@lisp
15477(setq nnmail-list-identifiers
15478 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
15479@end lisp
15480
15481This can also be done non-destructively with
15482@code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
15483
15484@item nnmail-remove-tabs
15485@findex nnmail-remove-tabs
15486Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
15487
01c52d31
MB
15488@item nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15489@findex nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15490@c @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
4009494e 15491@cindex Eudora
01c52d31
MB
15492@cindex Pegasus
15493Some mail user agents (e.g. Eudora and Pegasus) produce broken
15494@code{References} headers, but correct @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This
15495function will get rid of the @code{References} header if the headers
15496contain a line matching the regular expression
15497@code{nnmail-broken-references-mailers}.
4009494e
GM
15498
15499@end table
15500
15501@item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15502@vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15503This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
15504include:
15505
15506@table @code
15507@item article-de-quoted-unreadable
15508@findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
15509Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
15510
15511@end table
15512@end table
15513
15514
15515@node Duplicates
15516@subsection Duplicates
15517
15518@vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
15519@vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
15520@vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
15521@cindex duplicate mails
15522If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
15523receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
15524@code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
15525this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
15526@code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
15527default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
15528there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
15529variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
15530stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
15531@code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
15532default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
15533will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
15534that this is a duplicate of a different message.
15535
15536This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
15537will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
15538the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
15539@code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
15540
15541You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
15542@code{nil}.
15543
15544If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
15545@dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
15546methods:
15547
15548@lisp
15549(setq nnmail-split-fancy
15550 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
15551 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
15552 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
15553 (any mail "mail.misc")
15554 ;; @r{Other rules.}
15555 [...] ))
15556@end lisp
15557@noindent
15558Or something like:
15559@lisp
15560(setq nnmail-split-methods
15561 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
15562 ;; @r{Other rules.}
15563 [...]))
15564@end lisp
15565
15566Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
15567with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
15568@code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
15569using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
15570received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
15571
15572
15573@node Not Reading Mail
15574@subsection Not Reading Mail
15575
15576If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
15577habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
15578be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
15579
15580If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
15581@code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
15582mail, which should help.
15583
15584@vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
15585@vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
15586@vindex nnml-get-new-mail
15587@vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
15588@vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15589This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
15590happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old Rmail
15591file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
15592variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
15593the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
15594group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
15595
15596All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
15597narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
15598incoming mail.
15599
15600
15601@node Choosing a Mail Back End
15602@subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
15603
15604Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
15605file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
15606depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
15607
15608There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
15609back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
15610(because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
15611Spool}).
15612
15613@menu
15614* Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
15615* Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
15616* Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
15617* MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
15618* Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
15619* Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
15620* Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
15621@end menu
15622
15623
15624@node Unix Mail Box
15625@subsubsection Unix Mail Box
15626@cindex nnmbox
15627@cindex unix mail box
15628
15629@vindex nnmbox-active-file
15630@vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
15631The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
15632mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
15633which group it belongs in.
15634
15635Virtual server settings:
15636
15637@table @code
15638@item nnmbox-mbox-file
15639@vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
15640The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
15641@file{~/mbox}.
15642
15643@item nnmbox-active-file
15644@vindex nnmbox-active-file
15645The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
15646@file{~/.mbox-active}.
15647
15648@item nnmbox-get-new-mail
15649@vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
15650If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
15651into groups. Default is @code{t}.
15652@end table
15653
15654
15655@node Rmail Babyl
15656@subsubsection Rmail Babyl
15657@cindex nnbabyl
15658@cindex Rmail mbox
15659
15660@vindex nnbabyl-active-file
15661@vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
15662The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{Rmail
15663mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
15664mail article to say which group it belongs in.
15665
15666Virtual server settings:
15667
15668@table @code
15669@item nnbabyl-mbox-file
15670@vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
15671The name of the Rmail mbox file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
15672
15673@item nnbabyl-active-file
15674@vindex nnbabyl-active-file
15675The name of the active file for the rmail box. The default is
15676@file{~/.rmail-active}
15677
15678@item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
15679@vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
15680If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
15681@code{t}
15682@end table
15683
15684
15685@node Mail Spool
15686@subsubsection Mail Spool
15687@cindex nnml
15688@cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
15689
15690The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
15691format. It should be used with some caution.
15692
15693@vindex nnml-directory
15694If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
15695one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
15696directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
15697variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
15698
15699You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
15700care of all that.
15701
15702If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
15703in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
15704own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
15705weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
15706having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
15707shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
15708know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
15709to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
15710
15711@code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
15712splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
15713@acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
15714fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
15715
15716@cindex self contained nnml servers
15717@cindex marks
15718When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
15719servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15720similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15721proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
01c52d31 15722for a group are usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
4009494e
GM
15723@code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
15724Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
15725to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
15726directory).
15727
15728If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
15729up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
15730them next time it starts.
15731
15732Virtual server settings:
15733
15734@table @code
15735@item nnml-directory
15736@vindex nnml-directory
15737All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
15738default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
15739is @file{~/Mail}).
15740
15741@item nnml-active-file
15742@vindex nnml-active-file
15743The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
15744@file{~/Mail/active}.
15745
15746@item nnml-newsgroups-file
15747@vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
15748The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15749Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
15750
15751@item nnml-get-new-mail
15752@vindex nnml-get-new-mail
15753If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
15754@code{t}.
15755
15756@item nnml-nov-is-evil
15757@vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
15758If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15759default is @code{nil}.
15760
15761@item nnml-nov-file-name
15762@vindex nnml-nov-file-name
15763The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
15764
15765@item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
15766@vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
15767Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
15768
15769@item nnml-marks-is-evil
15770@vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
15771If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15772default is @code{nil}.
15773
15774@item nnml-marks-file-name
15775@vindex nnml-marks-file-name
15776The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
15777
15778@item nnml-use-compressed-files
15779@vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
15780If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
01c52d31
MB
15781files. This requires @code{auto-compression-mode} to be enabled
15782(@pxref{Compressed Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
15783If the value of @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is a string, it is used
15784as the file extension specifying the compression program. You can set it
15785to @samp{.bz2} if your Emacs supports it. A value of @code{t} is
15786equivalent to @samp{.gz}.
15787
15788@item nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
15789@vindex nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
15790Default size threshold for compressed message files. Message files with
15791bodies larger than that many characters will be automatically compressed
15792if @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil}.
4009494e
GM
15793
15794@end table
15795
15796@findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
15797If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
15798whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
15799nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
15800entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
15801might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
15802functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
15803Commands}).
15804
15805
15806@node MH Spool
15807@subsubsection MH Spool
15808@cindex nnmh
15809@cindex mh-e mail spool
15810
15811@code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
15812@acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
15813file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
15814@code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
15815for.
15816
15817Virtual server settings:
15818
15819@table @code
15820@item nnmh-directory
15821@vindex nnmh-directory
15822All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
15823default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
15824@file{~/Mail})
15825
15826@item nnmh-get-new-mail
15827@vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
15828If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
15829@code{t}.
15830
15831@item nnmh-be-safe
15832@vindex nnmh-be-safe
15833If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
15834sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
15835they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
15836setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
15837use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
15838have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
15839@end table
15840
15841
15842@node Maildir
15843@subsubsection Maildir
15844@cindex nnmaildir
15845@cindex maildir
15846
15847@code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
15848corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
15849@uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
15850@uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
15851also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
15852within a maildir.
15853
15854Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
15855reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
15856your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
15857configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
15858can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
15859configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
15860that appear as group in Gnus.
15861
15862@code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
15863never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
15864corrupt its data in the filesystem.
15865
15866@code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
15867maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
15868another, and you will keep your marks.
15869
15870Virtual server settings:
15871
15872@table @code
15873@item directory
15874For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
15875you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
15876it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
15877choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
15878will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
15879filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
15880in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
15881scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
15882the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
15883@code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
15884
15885The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
15886which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
15887the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
15888only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
15889server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
15890don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
15891optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
15892@code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
15893use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
15894if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
15895value.
15896
15897@item target-prefix
15898This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
15899@code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
15900server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
15901closed.
15902
15903When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
15904created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
15905pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
15906So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
15907@code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
15908the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
15909@file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
15910@file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
15911@file{../maildirs/foo}.
15912
15913You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
15914create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
15915this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
15916with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
15917symlinks pointing to them will be).
15918
15919As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
15920then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
15921@code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
15922cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
15923@code{force} argument.
15924
15925@item directory-files
15926This should be a function with the same interface as
15927@code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
15928used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
15929parameter is optional; the default is
15930@code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
15931@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
15932@code{directory-files} otherwise.
15933(@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
15934server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
15935scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
15936
15937@item get-new-mail
15938If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
15939maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
15940the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
15941@code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
15942value is @code{nil}.
15943
15944Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
15945an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
15946that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
15947different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
15948remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
15949@end table
15950
15951@subsubsection Group parameters
15952
15953@code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
15954all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
15955default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
15956one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
15957functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
15958you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
15959another back end.
15960
15961If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
15962is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
15963original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
15964evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
15965different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
15966back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
15967numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
15968@code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
15969quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
15970
15971@table @code
15972@item expire-age
15973An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
15974before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
15975articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
15976@code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
15977@code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
15978@code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
15979and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
15980wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
1598160 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
15982An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
15983modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
15984delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
15985article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
15986
15987@item expire-group
15988If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
15989@example
15990"backend+server.address.string:group.name"
15991@end example
15992and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
15993to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
15994before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
15995group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
15996was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
15997destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
15998the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
15999you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
16000article. So that form can refer to
16001@code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
16002article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
16003does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
16004@code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
16005
16006@item read-only
16007If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
16008in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
16009from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
16010@file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
16011cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
16012@file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
16013containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
16014maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
16015a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
16016have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
16017contain extra copies of the articles.
16018
16019@item directory-files
16020A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
16021used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
16022group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
16023server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
16024
16025@item distrust-Lines:
16026If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
16027article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
16028@code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
16029
16030@item always-marks
16031A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
16032Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16033say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
16034marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
16035feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
16036in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16037
16038@item never-marks
16039A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
16040Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16041say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
16042stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
16043@code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
16044probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
16045abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16046
16047@item nov-cache-size
16048An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
16049speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
16050for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
16051worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
16052parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
16053the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
16054The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
16055and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
16056that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
16057that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
16058@code{read}, plus a little extra.
16059@end table
16060
16061@subsubsection Article identification
16062Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
16063Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
16064contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
16065@code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
16066the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
16067identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
16068@file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
16069about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
16070available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
16071request the article in the summary buffer.
16072
16073@subsubsection NOV data
16074An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
16075to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
16076@code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
16077@code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
16078need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
16079when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
16080force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
16081single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
16082file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
16083assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
16084with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
16085
16086@subsubsection Article marks
16087An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
16088@code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
16089When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16090looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
16091asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16092creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
16093rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
16094links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
16095
16096You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
16097@file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
16098your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
16099remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
16100this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
16101it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
16102type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
16103@kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
16104pick up the changes, and might undo them.
16105
16106
16107@node Mail Folders
16108@subsubsection Mail Folders
16109@cindex nnfolder
16110@cindex mbox folders
16111@cindex mail folders
16112
16113@code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
16114separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
16115@code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
16116numbers and arrival dates.
16117
16118@cindex self contained nnfolder servers
16119@cindex marks
16120When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
16121servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
16122similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
16123proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
16124Marks for a group are usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
16125with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
16126@code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
16127directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
16128backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
16129into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
16130
16131Virtual server settings:
16132
16133@table @code
16134@item nnfolder-directory
16135@vindex nnfolder-directory
16136All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
16137directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
16138(whose default is @file{~/Mail})
16139
16140@item nnfolder-active-file
16141@vindex nnfolder-active-file
16142The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
16143
16144@item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16145@vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16146The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16147Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
16148
16149@item nnfolder-get-new-mail
16150@vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16151If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
16152default is @code{t}
16153
16154@item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16155@vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16156@cindex backup files
16157Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
16158backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
16159you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
16160following in your @file{.emacs} file:
16161
16162@lisp
16163(defun turn-off-backup ()
16164 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
16165
16166(add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
16167@end lisp
16168
16169@item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16170@vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16171Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
16172This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
16173extract some information from it before removing it.
16174
16175@item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16176@vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16177If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16178default is @code{nil}.
16179
16180@item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16181@vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16182The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
16183
16184@item nnfolder-nov-directory
16185@vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
16186The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
16187@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
16188
16189@item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
16190@vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
16191If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
16192default is @code{nil}.
16193
16194@item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
16195@vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
16196The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
16197
16198@item nnfolder-marks-directory
16199@vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
16200The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
16201@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
16202
16203@end table
16204
16205
16206@findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
16207@kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
16208If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
16209@code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
16210command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
16211@code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
16212though.
16213
16214@node Comparing Mail Back Ends
16215@subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
16216
16217First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
16218low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
16219is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
16220and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
16221mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
16222
16223The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
16224typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
16225in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
16226articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
16227access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
16228area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
16229@code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
16230actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
16231via NFS).
16232
16233The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
16234simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
16235format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
16236future. Here are some high and low points on each:
16237
16238@table @code
16239@item nnmbox
16240
16241UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
16242defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
16243they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
16244@samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
16245to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
16246@samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
16247historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
16248mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
16249this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
16250area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
16251(appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
16252to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
16253fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
16254what's where.
16255
16256@item nnbabyl
16257
16258Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
16259systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
16260reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
16261was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
16262format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
16263spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
16264headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
16265Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
16266and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
16267to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
16268VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
16269perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
16270headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
16271course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
16272
16273Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
16274file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
16275look at your mail.
16276
16277@item nnml
16278
16279@code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
16280actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
16281fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
16282lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
16283and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
16284Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
16285CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
16286or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
16287@dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
16288@acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
16289due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
16290file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
16291extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
16292provided by the active file and overviews.
16293
16294@code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
16295resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
16296files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
16297tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
16298the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
16299wins big.
16300
16301It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
16302FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
16303tiny files.
16304
16305@item nnmh
16306
16307The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
16308long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
16309individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
16310is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
16311active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
16312one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
16313slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
16314
16315@item nnfolder
16316
16317Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
16318method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
16319itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
16320little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
16321a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
16322can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
16323format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
16324it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
16325out how many messages there are in each separate group.
16326
16327If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
16328messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
16329only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
16330friendly mail back end all over.
16331
16332@item nnmaildir
16333
16334For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
16335incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
16336mail back ends.
16337
16338@code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
16339differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
16340filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
16341also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
16342per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
16343@code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
16344you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to
16345@uref{http://www.namesys.com/, ReiserFS} or another non-block-structured
16346file system.
16347
16348Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
16349as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
16350This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
16351organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
16352entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
16353require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
16354thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
16355whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
16356@code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
16357@code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
16358undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
16359
16360@code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
16361corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
16362them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
16363else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
16364it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
16365@code{nnmaildir}.
16366
16367@code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
16368(It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
16369and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
16370is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
16371parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
16372would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
16373removed in the future.
16374
16375Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
16376back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
16377on your file system.
16378
16379@code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
16380to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
16381
16382@end table
16383
16384
16385@node Browsing the Web
16386@section Browsing the Web
16387@cindex web
16388@cindex browsing the web
16389@cindex www
16390@cindex http
16391
16392Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
16393subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
16394eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
16395is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
16396and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
16397go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
16398even know what a news group is.
16399
16400The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
16401being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
16402they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
16403not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
16404you mad in the end.
16405
16406So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
16407to do it instead?
16408
16409Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
16410interfaces to these sources.
16411
16412@menu
16413* Archiving Mail::
16414* Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
16415* Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
16416* Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
16417* Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
16418* RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
16419* Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
16420@end menu
16421
16422All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
16423alternatives to work.
16424
16425The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
16426work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
16427is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
16428will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
16429though, you should be ok.
16430
16431One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
16432are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
16433cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
16434Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
16435leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
16436
16437@node Archiving Mail
16438@subsection Archiving Mail
16439@cindex archiving mail
16440@cindex backup of mail
16441
16442Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
16443@code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
16444For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
16445marks is fairly simple.
16446
16447(Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
16448requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
16449though.)
16450
16451To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
16452server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
16453to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
16454similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
16455adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
16456@ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
16457might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
16458before you restore the data.
16459
16460It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
16461@code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
16462For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
16463directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
16464file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
16465this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
16466buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
16467@code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
16468is unnecessary in that case.
16469
16470@node Web Searches
16471@subsection Web Searches
16472@cindex nnweb
16473@cindex Google
16474@cindex dejanews
16475@cindex gmane
16476@cindex Usenet searches
16477@cindex searching the Usenet
16478
16479It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
16480string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
16481those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
16482the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
16483searches without having to use a browser.
16484
16485The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
16486engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
16487then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
16488group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
16489Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
16490
16491@code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
16492groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
16493each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
16494pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
16495manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
16496Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
16497@code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
16498engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
16499of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
16500header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
16501group as read.
16502
16503If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
16504won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
01c52d31 16505providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'@^etre} is to
4009494e
GM
16506make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
16507community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
16508might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
16509
16510You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
16511(try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
16512installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
16513
16514Virtual server variables:
16515
16516@table @code
16517@item nnweb-type
16518@vindex nnweb-type
16519What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
16520are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
16521@code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
16522
16523@item nnweb-search
16524@vindex nnweb-search
16525The search string to feed to the search engine.
16526
16527@item nnweb-max-hits
16528@vindex nnweb-max-hits
16529Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
16530999.
16531
16532@item nnweb-type-definition
16533@vindex nnweb-type-definition
16534Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
16535with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
16536present:
16537
16538@table @code
16539@item article
16540Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
16541understands.
16542
16543@item map
16544Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
16545
16546@item search
16547Function to send the search string to the search engine.
16548
16549@item address
16550The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
16551to.
16552
16553@item id
16554Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
16555@end table
16556
16557@end table
16558
16559
16560@node Slashdot
16561@subsection Slashdot
16562@cindex Slashdot
16563@cindex nnslashdot
16564
16565@uref{http://slashdot.org/, Slashdot} is a popular news site, with
16566lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
16567let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
16568
16569The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
16570following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
16571
16572@lisp
16573(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
16574 '((nnslashdot "")))
16575@end lisp
16576
16577This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
16578and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
16579a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
16580groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
16581groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
16582Methods}).
16583
16584If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
16585command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
16586
16587When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
16588comments), some light @acronym{HTML}izations will be performed. In
16589particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
16590@samp{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @samp{br} added to
16591the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @acronym{HTML}
16592directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
16593@acronym{HTML} forms.
16594
16595The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
16596
16597@table @code
16598@item nnslashdot-threaded
16599Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
16600default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
16601has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
16602threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
16603the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
16604but much, much slower than unthreaded.
16605
16606@item nnslashdot-login-name
16607@vindex nnslashdot-login-name
16608The login name to use when posting.
16609
16610@item nnslashdot-password
16611@vindex nnslashdot-password
16612The password to use when posting.
16613
16614@item nnslashdot-directory
16615@vindex nnslashdot-directory
16616Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
16617@file{~/News/slashdot/}.
16618
16619@item nnslashdot-active-url
16620@vindex nnslashdot-active-url
16621The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the
16622information on news articles and comments. The default is@*
16623@samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
16624
16625@item nnslashdot-comments-url
16626@vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
16627The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch comments.
16628
16629@item nnslashdot-article-url
16630@vindex nnslashdot-article-url
16631The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the news
16632article. The default is
16633@samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
16634
16635@item nnslashdot-threshold
16636@vindex nnslashdot-threshold
16637The score threshold. The default is -1.
16638
16639@item nnslashdot-group-number
16640@vindex nnslashdot-group-number
16641The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
16642updated. The default is 0.
16643
16644@end table
16645
16646
16647
16648@node Ultimate
16649@subsection Ultimate
16650@cindex nnultimate
16651@cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
16652
16653@uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/, The Ultimate Bulletin Board} is
16654probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
16655quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
16656information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16657
16658The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
16659something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
16660http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @acronym{URL}
16661(not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
16662you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
16663site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
16664server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
16665
16666The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
16667
16668@table @code
16669@item nnultimate-directory
16670@vindex nnultimate-directory
16671The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is@*
16672@file{~/News/ultimate/}.
16673@end table
16674
16675
16676@node Web Archive
16677@subsection Web Archive
16678@cindex nnwarchive
16679@cindex Web Archive
16680
16681Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
16682@uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
16683@uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
16684interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
16685groups updated.
16686
16687@findex gnus-group-make-warchive-group
16688The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
16689something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
16690gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET @var{an_egroup} RET egroups RET
16691www.egroups.com RET @var{your@@email.address} RET}. (Substitute the
16692@var{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
16693@var{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
16694back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
16695
16696The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
16697
16698@table @code
16699@item nnwarchive-directory
16700@vindex nnwarchive-directory
16701The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is@*
16702@file{~/News/warchive/}.
16703
16704@item nnwarchive-login
16705@vindex nnwarchive-login
16706The account name on the web server.
16707
16708@item nnwarchive-passwd
16709@vindex nnwarchive-passwd
16710The password for your account on the web server.
16711@end table
16712
16713@node RSS
16714@subsection RSS
16715@cindex nnrss
16716@cindex RSS
16717
16718Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
16719@acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
16720sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
16721presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
16722changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
16723
16724@acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
16725possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16726
16727Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
16728system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
16729text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
16730group names.
16731
16732@kindex G R (Group)
16733Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
16734prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
16735The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
16736and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
16737
16738An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
16739the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
16740subscribe to groups.
16741
16742The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
16743@code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
16744names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
16745coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
16746variable. If it is @code{nil}, in Emacs the coding system defaults to
16747the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system}. If you are using
16748XEmacs and want to use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names, you should set
16749the value for the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} variable properly.
16750
16751The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
16752@acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
16753and a @samp{text/html} part.
16754
16755@cindex OPML
16756You can also use the following commands to import and export your
16757subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
16758Markup Language).
16759
16760@defun nnrss-opml-import file
16761Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
16762file.
16763@end defun
16764
16765@defun nnrss-opml-export
16766Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
16767@acronym{OPML} format.
16768@end defun
16769
16770The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
16771
16772@table @code
16773@item nnrss-directory
16774@vindex nnrss-directory
16775The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
16776@file{~/News/rss/}.
16777
16778@item nnrss-file-coding-system
16779@vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
16780The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
16781data files. The default is the value of
16782@code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
16783in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
16784
01c52d31
MB
16785@item nnrss-ignore-article-fields
16786@vindex nnrss-ignore-article-fields
16787Some feeds update constantly article fields during their publications,
16788e.g. to indicate the number of comments. However, if there is
16789a difference between the local article and the distant one, the latter
16790is considered to be new. To avoid this and discard some fields, set this
16791variable to the list of fields to be ignored. The default is
16792@code{'(slash:comments)}.
16793
4009494e
GM
16794@item nnrss-use-local
16795@vindex nnrss-use-local
16796@findex nnrss-generate-download-script
16797If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
16798the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
16799the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
16800download script using @command{wget}.
16801
16802@item nnrss-wash-html-in-text-plain-parts
16803Non-@code{nil} means that @code{nnrss} renders text in @samp{text/plain}
16804parts as @acronym{HTML}. The function specified by the
16805@code{mm-text-html-renderer} variable (@pxref{Display Customization,
16806,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) will be used
16807to render text. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default, text will
16808simply be folded. Leave it @code{nil} if you prefer to see
16809@samp{text/html} parts.
16810@end table
16811
16812The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
16813the summary buffer.
16814
16815@lisp
16816(add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
16817(setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
16818
16819(defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
16820 (let ((descr
16821 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
16822 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
16823@end lisp
16824
16825The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
16826summary buffer.
16827
16828@lisp
16829(require 'browse-url)
16830
01c52d31 16831(defun browse-nnrss-url (arg)
4009494e
GM
16832 (interactive "p")
16833 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
16834 (mail-header-extra
16835 (gnus-data-header
16836 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
16837 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
16838 (if url
16839 (progn
16840 (browse-url (cdr url))
16841 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
16842 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
16843
16844(eval-after-load "gnus"
16845 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
16846 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
16847(add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
16848@end lisp
16849
16850Even if you have added @code{"text/html"} to the
16851@code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
16852Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
16853Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
16854more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
16855@samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
16856@code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
16857Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
16858@code{nnrss} groups:
16859
16860@lisp
16861;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
16862(eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
16863 '(add-to-list
16864 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
16865 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
16866 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
16867
16868;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
16869(add-to-list
16870 'gnus-parameters
16871 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
16872@end lisp
16873
16874
16875@node Customizing W3
16876@subsection Customizing W3
16877@cindex W3
16878@cindex html
16879@cindex url
16880@cindex Netscape
16881
16882Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
16883alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
16884manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
16885users.
16886
16887For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
16888using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
16889browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
16890
16891@lisp
16892(eval-after-load "w3"
16893 '(progn
16894 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
16895 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
16896 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
16897 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
16898 (browse-url url)
16899 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
16900@end lisp
16901
16902Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
16903@acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
16904follow the link.
16905
16906
16907@node IMAP
16908@section IMAP
16909@cindex nnimap
16910@cindex @acronym{IMAP}
16911
16912@acronym{IMAP} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or @dots{}),
16913think of it as a modernized @acronym{NNTP}. Connecting to a @acronym{IMAP}
16914server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
16915specify the network address of the server.
16916
16917@acronym{IMAP} has two properties. First, @acronym{IMAP} can do
16918everything that @acronym{POP} can, it can hence be viewed as a
16919@acronym{POP++}. Secondly, @acronym{IMAP} is a mail storage protocol,
16920similar to @acronym{NNTP} being a news storage protocol---however,
16921@acronym{IMAP} offers more features than @acronym{NNTP} because news
16922is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
16923
16924If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a @acronym{POP++}, use an imap
16925entry in @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from
16926the @acronym{IMAP} server and store them on the local disk. This is
16927not the usage described in this section---@xref{Mail Sources}.
16928
16929If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
16930entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
16931manipulate mails stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server. This is the kind of
16932usage explained in this section.
16933
16934A server configuration in @file{~/.gnus.el} with a few @acronym{IMAP}
16935servers might look something like the following. (Note that for
16936@acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you need external programs and libraries,
16937see below.)
16938
16939@lisp
16940(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
16941 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; @r{no special configuration}
16942 ; @r{perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:}
16943 (nnimap "dolk"
16944 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16945 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
16946 ; @r{a UW server running on localhost}
16947 (nnimap "barbar"
16948 (nnimap-server-port 143)
16949 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16950 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
16951 ; @r{anonymous public cyrus server:}
16952 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
16953 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
16954 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
16955 (nnimap-stream network))
16956 ; @r{a ssl server on a non-standard port:}
16957 (nnimap "vic20"
16958 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
16959 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
16960 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
16961@end lisp
16962
16963After defining the new server, you can subscribe to groups on the
16964server using normal Gnus commands such as @kbd{U} in the Group Buffer
16965(@pxref{Subscription Commands}) or via the Server Buffer
16966(@pxref{Server Buffer}).
16967
16968The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
16969server:
16970
16971@table @code
16972
16973@item nnimap-address
16974@vindex nnimap-address
16975
16976The address of the remote @acronym{IMAP} server. Defaults to the virtual
16977server name if not specified.
16978
16979@item nnimap-server-port
16980@vindex nnimap-server-port
16981Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}.
16982
16983Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
16984
16985@lisp
16986(nnimap "mail.server.com"
16987 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
16988@end lisp
16989
16990@item nnimap-list-pattern
16991@vindex nnimap-list-pattern
16992String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
16993This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
16994interested in a few---some servers export your home directory via
16995@acronym{IMAP}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
16996@file{~/Mail/*} then.
16997
16998The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
16999REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
17000Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
17001mailbox.
17002
17003Example server specification:
17004
17005@lisp
17006(nnimap "mail.server.com"
17007 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
17008 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
17009@end lisp
17010
17011@item nnimap-stream
17012@vindex nnimap-stream
17013The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
17014will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
17015of @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}. (@acronym{IMAP} over
17016@acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can
17017be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
17018
17019Example server specification:
17020
17021@lisp
17022(nnimap "mail.server.com"
17023 (nnimap-stream ssl))
17024@end lisp
17025
17026Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
17027
17028@itemize @bullet
17029@item
17030@dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
17031@samp{gsasl} or @samp{imtest} program.
17032@item
17033@dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
17034@item
17035@dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
17036@acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
17037@samp{starttls}.
17038@item
17039@dfn{tls:} Connect through @acronym{TLS}. Requires GNUTLS (the program
17040@samp{gnutls-cli}).
17041@item
17042@dfn{ssl:} Connect through @acronym{SSL}. Requires OpenSSL (the program
17043@samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
17044@item
17045@dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @acronym{IMAP} connection.
17046@item
17047@dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
17048@end itemize
17049
17050@vindex imap-kerberos4-program
17051The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
17052using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
170531.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
17054to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
17055with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
17056restrictions on @acronym{IMAP} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
17057indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
17058@code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
17059program.
17060
17061For @acronym{TLS} connection, the @code{gnutls-cli} program from GNUTLS is
17062needed. It is available from
17063@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/}.
17064
17065@vindex imap-gssapi-program
17066This parameter specifies a list of command lines that invoke a GSSAPI
17067authenticated @acronym{IMAP} stream in a subshell. They are tried
17068sequentially until a connection is made, or the list has been
17069exhausted. By default, @samp{gsasl} from GNU SASL, available from
17070@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gsasl/}, and the @samp{imtest}
17071program from Cyrus IMAPD (see @code{imap-kerberos4-program}), are
17072tried.
17073
17074@vindex imap-ssl-program
17075For @acronym{SSL} connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
17076@uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
17077and nnimap support it too---although the most recent versions of
17078SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
17079useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
17080work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
17081to OpenSSL/SSLeay.
17082
17083@vindex imap-shell-program
17084@vindex imap-shell-host
01c52d31
MB
17085For @acronym{IMAP} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the
17086variable @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call. Make
17087sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g., don't
17088forget to redirect the error output to the void.
4009494e
GM
17089
17090@item nnimap-authenticator
17091@vindex nnimap-authenticator
17092
17093The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
17094will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
17095
17096Example server specification:
17097
17098@lisp
17099(nnimap "mail.server.com"
17100 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
17101@end lisp
17102
17103Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
17104
17105@itemize @bullet
17106@item
17107@dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
17108external program @code{gsasl} or @code{imtest}.
17109@item
17110@dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
17111@code{imtest}.
17112@item
17113@dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
17114external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
17115@item
17116@dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
17117@item
17118@dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
17119@item
17120@dfn{anonymous:} Login as ``anonymous'', supplying your email address as password.
17121@end itemize
17122
17123@item nnimap-expunge-on-close
17124@cindex expunging
17125@vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
17126Unlike Parmenides the @acronym{IMAP} designers have decided things that
17127don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @acronym{IMAP} has
17128this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
17129delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
17130nnimap does when you delete an article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
17131similar).
17132
17133Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
17134@code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
17135running in circles yet?
17136
17137Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
17138when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
17139variable.
17140
17141The possible options are:
17142
17143@table @code
17144
17145@item always
17146The default behavior, delete all articles marked as ``Deleted'' when
17147closing a mailbox.
17148@item never
17149Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
17150the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @acronym{IMAP} clients
17151may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
17152manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
17153@item ask
17154When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
17155articles or not.
17156
17157@end table
17158
17159@item nnimap-importantize-dormant
17160@vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
17161
17162If non-@code{nil} (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as
17163well), for other @acronym{IMAP} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
17164naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
17165articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @acronym{IMAP}
17166clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @acronym{IMAP}
17167has only one.)
17168
17169Probably the only reason for frobbing this would be if you're trying
17170enable per-user persistent dormant flags, using something like:
17171
17172@lisp
17173(setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
17174 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
17175(setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
17176 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
17177@end lisp
17178
17179In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
17180as ticked for other users.
17181
17182@item nnimap-expunge-search-string
17183@cindex expunging
17184@vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
17185@cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
17186
17187This variable contain the @acronym{IMAP} search command sent to server when
17188searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
17189@code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
17190UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
17191
17192Probably the only useful value to change this to is
17193@code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
17194messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
17195RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
17196
17197However, if @code{nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil}
17198is true, this variable has no effect since the search logic
17199is reversed, as described below.
17200
17201@item nnimap-authinfo-file
17202@vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
17203
17204A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
17205(almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
17206variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
17207@ref{NNTP}. An example of an .authinfo line for an IMAP server, is:
17208
17209@example
17210machine students.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis port imap
17211@end example
17212
17213Note that it should be @code{port imap}, or @code{port 143}, if you
17214use a @code{nnimap-stream} of @code{tls} or @code{ssl}, even if the
17215actual port number used is port 993 for secured IMAP. For
17216convenience, Gnus will accept @code{port imaps} as a synonym of
17217@code{port imap}.
17218
17219@item nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
17220@vindex nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
17221
17222Unselect mailboxes before looking for new mail in them. Some servers
17223seem to need this under some circumstances; it was reported that
17224Courier 1.7.1 did.
17225
17226@item nnimap-nov-is-evil
17227@vindex nnimap-nov-is-evil
17228@cindex Courier @acronym{IMAP} server
17229@cindex @acronym{NOV}
17230
17231Never generate or use a local @acronym{NOV} database. Defaults to the
17232value of @code{gnus-agent}.
17233
17234Using a @acronym{NOV} database usually makes header fetching much
17235faster, but it uses the @code{UID SEARCH UID} command, which is very
17236slow on some servers (notably some versions of Courier). Since the Gnus
17237Agent caches the information in the @acronym{NOV} database without using
17238the slow command, this variable defaults to true if the Agent is in use,
17239and false otherwise.
17240
17241@item nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil
17242@vindex nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil
17243@cindex Courier @acronym{IMAP} server
17244@cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
17245
17246Avoid the @code{UID SEARCH UID @var{message numbers} NOT SINCE
17247@var{date}} command, which is slow on some @acronym{IMAP} servers
17248(notably, some versions of Courier). Instead, use @code{UID SEARCH SINCE
17249@var{date}} and prune the list of expirable articles within Gnus.
17250
17251When Gnus expires your mail (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), it starts with a
17252list of expirable articles and asks the IMAP server questions like ``Of
17253these articles, which ones are older than a week?'' While this seems
17254like a perfectly reasonable question, some IMAP servers take a long time
17255to answer it, since they seemingly go looking into every old article to
17256see if it is one of the expirable ones. Curiously, the question ``Of
17257@emph{all} articles, which ones are newer than a week?'' seems to be
17258much faster to answer, so setting this variable causes Gnus to ask this
17259question and figure out the answer to the real question itself.
17260
17261This problem can really sneak up on you: when you first configure Gnus,
17262everything works fine, but once you accumulate a couple thousand
17263messages, you start cursing Gnus for being so slow. On the other hand,
17264if you get a lot of email within a week, setting this variable will
17265cause a lot of network traffic between Gnus and the IMAP server.
17266
01c52d31
MB
17267@item nnimap-logout-timeout
17268@vindex nnimap-logout-timeout
17269
17270There is a case where a connection to a @acronym{IMAP} server is unable
17271to close, when connecting to the server via a certain kind of network,
17272e.g. @acronym{VPN}. In that case, it will be observed that a connection
17273between Emacs and the local network looks alive even if the server has
17274closed a connection for some reason (typically, a timeout).
17275Consequently, Emacs continues waiting for a response from the server for
17276the @code{LOGOUT} command that Emacs sent, or hangs in other words. If
17277you are in such a network, setting this variable to a number of seconds
17278will be helpful. If it is set, a hung connection will be closed
17279forcibly, after this number of seconds from the time Emacs sends the
17280@code{LOGOUT} command. It should not be too small value but too large
17281value will be inconvenient too. Perhaps the value 1.0 will be a good
17282candidate but it might be worth trying some other values.
17283
17284Example server specification:
17285
17286@lisp
17287(nnimap "mail.server.com"
17288 (nnimap-logout-timeout 1.0))
17289@end lisp
17290
4009494e
GM
17291@end table
17292
17293@menu
17294* Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
17295* Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
17296* Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
17297* Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
17298* A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
17299* Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
17300@end menu
17301
17302
17303
17304@node Splitting in IMAP
17305@subsection Splitting in IMAP
17306@cindex splitting imap mail
17307
17308Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
17309the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
17310@acronym{IMAP} servers have server side splitting and those that have
17311splitting seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that
17312@acronym{IMAP} support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
17313
17314And it does.
17315
17316(Incidentally, people seem to have been dreaming on, and Sieve has
17317gaining a market share and is supported by several IMAP servers.
17318Fortunately, Gnus support it too, @xref{Sieve Commands}.)
17319
17320Here are the variables of interest:
17321
17322@table @code
17323
17324@item nnimap-split-crosspost
17325@cindex splitting, crosspost
17326@cindex crosspost
17327@vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
17328
17329If non-@code{nil}, do crossposting if several split methods match the
17330mail. If @code{nil}, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule}
17331found will be used.
17332
17333Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
17334
17335@item nnimap-split-inbox
17336@cindex splitting, inbox
17337@cindex inbox
17338@vindex nnimap-split-inbox
17339
17340A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @acronym{IMAP}
17341mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
17342splitting is disabled!
17343
17344@lisp
17345(setq nnimap-split-inbox
17346 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
17347@end lisp
17348
17349No nnmail equivalent.
17350
17351@item nnimap-split-rule
17352@cindex splitting, rules
17353@vindex nnimap-split-rule
17354
17355New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
17356this variable.
17357
17358This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
17359sublist gives the name of the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox to move articles
17360matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
17361Neither did I, we need examples.
17362
17363@lisp
17364(setq nnimap-split-rule
17365 '(("INBOX.nnimap"
17366 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
17367 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
17368 ("INBOX.private" "")))
17369@end lisp
17370
17371This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
17372INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
17373into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
17374
17375The first string may contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by
17376replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
17377instance:
17378
17379@lisp
17380("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
17381@end lisp
17382
17383The first element can also be the symbol @code{junk} to indicate that
17384matching messages should simply be deleted. Use with care.
17385
17386The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
17387called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
17388containing the headers of the article. It should return a
17389non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
17390
17391Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
17392match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
17393nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
17394of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
17395unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
17396them every time you fetch new mail.)
17397
17398These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
17399end. The first rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have
17400crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.
17401
17402This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
17403be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
17404thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
17405
17406The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
17407
17408To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
17409even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
17410the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
17411
17412@lisp
17413(setq nnimap-split-rule
17414 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
17415 ("junk" "From:.*Simon"))))
17416 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
17417 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
17418 ("junk" my-junk-func))))))
17419@end lisp
17420
17421The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
17422may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
17423@code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
17424Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
17425rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
17426group/function elements.
17427
17428Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
17429
17430@item nnimap-split-predicate
17431@cindex splitting
17432@vindex nnimap-split-predicate
17433
17434Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
17435split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
17436
17437This might be useful if you use another @acronym{IMAP} client to read mail in
17438your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
17439regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
17440@samp{UNDELETED}.
17441
17442@item nnimap-split-fancy
17443@cindex splitting, fancy
17444@findex nnimap-split-fancy
17445@vindex nnimap-split-fancy
17446
17447It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
17448@code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
17449splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
17450
17451However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
17452nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
17453@code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
17454rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
17455
17456Example:
17457
17458@lisp
17459(setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
17460 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
17461@end lisp
17462
17463Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
17464
17465@item nnimap-split-download-body
17466@findex nnimap-split-download-body
17467@vindex nnimap-split-download-body
17468
17469Set to non-@code{nil} to download entire articles during splitting.
17470This is generally not required, and will slow things down
17471considerably. You may need it if you want to use an advanced
17472splitting function that analyzes the body to split the article.
17473
17474@end table
17475
17476@node Expiring in IMAP
17477@subsection Expiring in IMAP
17478@cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
17479
17480Even though @code{nnimap} is not a proper @code{nnmail} derived back
17481end, it supports most features in regular expiring (@pxref{Expiring
17482Mail}). Unlike splitting in @acronym{IMAP} (@pxref{Splitting in
17483IMAP}) it does not clone the @code{nnmail} variables (i.e., creating
17484@var{nnimap-expiry-wait}) but reuse the @code{nnmail} variables. What
17485follows below are the variables used by the @code{nnimap} expiry
17486process.
17487
17488A note on how the expire mark is stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server is
17489appropriate here as well. The expire mark is translated into a
17490@code{imap} client specific mark, @code{gnus-expire}, and stored on the
17491message. This means that likely only Gnus will understand and treat
17492the @code{gnus-expire} mark properly, although other clients may allow
17493you to view client specific flags on the message. It also means that
17494your server must support permanent storage of client specific flags on
17495messages. Most do, fortunately.
17496
17497If expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail seems very slow, try setting the server
17498variable @code{nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil}.
17499
17500@table @code
17501
17502@item nnmail-expiry-wait
17503@item nnmail-expiry-wait-function
17504
17505These variables are fully supported. The expire value can be a
17506number, the symbol @code{immediate} or @code{never}.
17507
17508@item nnmail-expiry-target
17509
17510This variable is supported, and internally implemented by calling the
17511@code{nnmail} functions that handle this. It contains an optimization
17512that if the destination is a @acronym{IMAP} group on the same server, the
17513article is copied instead of appended (that is, uploaded again).
17514
17515@end table
17516
17517@node Editing IMAP ACLs
17518@subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
17519@cindex editing imap acls
17520@cindex Access Control Lists
17521@cindex Editing @acronym{IMAP} ACLs
17522@kindex G l (Group)
17523@findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
17524
17525ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @acronym{IMAP} for
17526limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
17527@acronym{IMAP} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
17528doesn't.
17529
17530To edit an ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
17531(@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with an ACL
17532editing window with detailed instructions.
17533
17534Some possible uses:
17535
17536@itemize @bullet
17537@item
17538Giving ``anyone'' the ``lrs'' rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
17539on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
17540follow the list without subscribing to it.
17541@item
17542At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
17543``anyone'' posting ("p") capabilities to have ``plussing'' work (that is,
17544mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox
17545INBOX.mailbox).
17546@end itemize
17547
17548@node Expunging mailboxes
17549@subsection Expunging mailboxes
17550@cindex expunging
17551
17552@cindex expunge
17553@cindex manual expunging
17554@kindex G x (Group)
17555@findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
17556
17557If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
17558you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
17559manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
17560
17561Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
17562delete them.
17563
17564@node A note on namespaces
17565@subsection A note on namespaces
17566@cindex IMAP namespace
17567@cindex namespaces
17568
17569The @acronym{IMAP} protocol has a concept called namespaces, described
17570by the following text in the RFC2060:
17571
17572@display
175735.1.2. Mailbox Namespace Naming Convention
17574
17575 By convention, the first hierarchical element of any mailbox name
17576 which begins with "#" identifies the "namespace" of the remainder of
17577 the name. This makes it possible to disambiguate between different
17578 types of mailbox stores, each of which have their own namespaces.
17579
17580 For example, implementations which offer access to USENET
17581 newsgroups MAY use the "#news" namespace to partition the USENET
17582 newsgroup namespace from that of other mailboxes. Thus, the
17583 comp.mail.misc newsgroup would have an mailbox name of
17584 "#news.comp.mail.misc", and the name "comp.mail.misc" could refer
17585 to a different object (e.g. a user's private mailbox).
17586@end display
17587
17588While there is nothing in this text that warrants concern for the
17589@acronym{IMAP} implementation in Gnus, some servers use namespace
17590prefixes in a way that does not work with how Gnus uses mailbox names.
17591
17592Specifically, University of Washington's @acronym{IMAP} server uses
17593mailbox names like @code{#driver.mbx/read-mail} which are valid only
17594in the @sc{create} and @sc{append} commands. After the mailbox is
17595created (or a messages is appended to a mailbox), it must be accessed
17596without the namespace prefix, i.e. @code{read-mail}. Since Gnus do
17597not make it possible for the user to guarantee that user entered
17598mailbox names will only be used with the CREATE and APPEND commands,
17599you should simply not use the namespace prefixed mailbox names in
17600Gnus.
17601
17602See the UoW IMAPD documentation for the @code{#driver.*/} prefix
17603for more information on how to use the prefixes. They are a power
17604tool and should be used only if you are sure what the effects are.
17605
17606@node Debugging IMAP
17607@subsection Debugging IMAP
17608@cindex IMAP debugging
17609@cindex protocol dump (IMAP)
17610
17611@acronym{IMAP} is a complex protocol, more so than @acronym{NNTP} or
17612@acronym{POP3}. Implementation bugs are not unlikely, and we do our
17613best to fix them right away. If you encounter odd behavior, chances
17614are that either the server or Gnus is buggy.
17615
17616If you are familiar with network protocols in general, you will
17617probably be able to extract some clues from the protocol dump of the
17618exchanges between Gnus and the server. Even if you are not familiar
17619with network protocols, when you include the protocol dump in
17620@acronym{IMAP}-related bug reports you are helping us with data
17621critical to solving the problem. Therefore, we strongly encourage you
17622to include the protocol dump when reporting IMAP bugs in Gnus.
17623
17624
17625@vindex imap-log
17626Because the protocol dump, when enabled, generates lots of data, it is
17627disabled by default. You can enable it by setting @code{imap-log} as
17628follows:
17629
17630@lisp
17631(setq imap-log t)
17632@end lisp
17633
17634This instructs the @code{imap.el} package to log any exchanges with
17635the server. The log is stored in the buffer @samp{*imap-log*}. Look
17636for error messages, which sometimes are tagged with the keyword
17637@code{BAD}---but when submitting a bug, make sure to include all the
17638data.
17639
17640@node Other Sources
17641@section Other Sources
17642
17643Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
17644below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
17645newsgroups.
17646
17647@menu
17648* Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
17649* Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
17650* Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
17651* SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
17652* Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
17653@end menu
17654
17655
17656@node Directory Groups
17657@subsection Directory Groups
17658@cindex nndir
17659@cindex directory groups
17660
17661If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
17662it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
17663names, of course.
17664
17665This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
17666successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
17667packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
17668back end to read directories. Big deal.
17669
17670@code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
17671enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
17672@file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
17673@code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
17674directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
17675
17676@code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
17677
17678@code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
17679articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
17680whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
17681methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
17682
17683
17684@node Anything Groups
17685@subsection Anything Groups
17686@cindex nneething
17687
17688From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
17689directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
17690pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
17691true.
17692
17693When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
17694directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
17695a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
17696After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
17697@code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
17698file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
17699few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
17700just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
17701@code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
17702file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
17703elements.
17704
17705All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
17706with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
17707newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
17708in the article buffer, just as usual.
17709
17710If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
17711a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
17712traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
17713Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
17714
17715There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
17716doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
17717will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
17718are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
17719normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
17720article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
17721other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
17722be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
17723
17724Some variables:
17725
17726@table @code
17727@item nneething-map-file-directory
17728@vindex nneething-map-file-directory
17729All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
17730in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
17731
17732@item nneething-exclude-files
17733@vindex nneething-exclude-files
17734All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
17735auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
17736
17737@item nneething-include-files
17738@vindex nneething-include-files
17739Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
17740non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
17741
17742@item nneething-map-file
17743@vindex nneething-map-file
17744Name of the map files.
17745@end table
17746
17747
17748@node Document Groups
17749@subsection Document Groups
17750@cindex nndoc
17751@cindex documentation group
17752@cindex help group
17753
17754@code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
17755as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
17756
17757@table @code
17758@cindex Babyl
17759@cindex Rmail mbox
17760@item babyl
17761The Babyl (Rmail) mail box.
17762
17763@cindex mbox
17764@cindex Unix mbox
17765@item mbox
17766The standard Unix mbox file.
17767
17768@cindex MMDF mail box
17769@item mmdf
17770The MMDF mail box format.
17771
17772@item news
17773Several news articles appended into a file.
17774
17775@cindex rnews batch files
17776@item rnews
17777The rnews batch transport format.
17778
17779@item nsmail
17780Netscape mail boxes.
17781
17782@item mime-parts
17783@acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
17784
17785@item standard-digest
17786The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
17787
17788@item mime-digest
17789A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
17790
17791@item lanl-gov-announce
17792Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
17793
17794@cindex forwarded messages
17795@item rfc822-forward
17796A message forwarded according to RFC822.
17797
17798@item outlook
17799The Outlook mail box.
17800
17801@item oe-dbx
17802The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
17803
17804@item exim-bounce
17805A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
17806
17807@item forward
17808A message forwarded according to informal rules.
17809
17810@item rfc934
17811An RFC934-forwarded message.
17812
17813@item mailman
17814A mailman digest.
17815
17816@item clari-briefs
17817A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
17818
17819@item slack-digest
17820Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17821
17822@item mail-in-mail
17823The last resort.
17824@end table
17825
17826You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17827that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17828@code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17829file is.
17830
17831@code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17832it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17833group. And that's it.
17834
17835If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17836new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17837that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17838to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17839@code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17840(@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17841the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17842using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17843file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17844delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
17845
17846Virtual server variables:
17847
17848@table @code
17849@item nndoc-article-type
17850@vindex nndoc-article-type
17851This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17852@code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17853@code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17854@code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17855@code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
17856
17857@item nndoc-post-type
17858@vindex nndoc-post-type
17859This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17860a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17861and @code{news}.
17862@end table
17863
17864@menu
17865* Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17866@end menu
17867
17868
17869@node Document Server Internals
17870@subsubsection Document Server Internals
17871
17872Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17873difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17874looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17875and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
17876
17877First, here's an example document type definition:
17878
17879@example
17880(mmdf
17881 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17882 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17883@end example
17884
17885The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17886regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17887variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17888types can be defined with very few settings:
17889
17890@table @code
17891@item first-article
17892If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17893something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17894totally ignored.
17895
17896@item article-begin
17897This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17898says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17899complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17900use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
17901
17902@item article-begin-function
17903If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17904of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
17905
17906@item head-begin
17907If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17908article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17909simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17910
17911@item head-begin-function
17912If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17913the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17914
17915@item head-end
17916This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17917@samp{^$}---the empty line.
17918
17919@item body-begin
17920This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17921to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17922a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17923
17924@item body-begin-function
17925If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17926of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17927
17928@item body-end
17929If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17930more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17931can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17932
17933@item body-end-function
17934If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17935the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17936
17937@item file-begin
17938If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17939before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17940
17941@item file-end
17942If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17943regexp will be totally ignored.
17944
17945@end table
17946
17947So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17948file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17949few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17950news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17951something that's palatable for Gnus:
17952
17953@table @code
17954@item prepare-body-function
17955If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17956will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17957document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17958
17959@item article-transform-function
17960If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17961meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17962body of the article.
17963
17964@item generate-head-function
17965If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17966understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17967expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17968called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17969
17970@item generate-article-function
17971If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17972Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17973parameter when requesting all articles.
17974
17975@item dissection-function
17976If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17977overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17978@code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17979@code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17980@code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17981@code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17982
17983@end table
17984
17985Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17986digests:
17987
17988@example
17989(standard-digest
17990 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17991 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17992 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17993 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17994 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17995 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17996 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17997 (subtype digest guess))
17998@end example
17999
18000We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
18001text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
18002each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
18003the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
18004run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
18005
18006To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
18007@code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
18008is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
18009where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
18010The alist is traversed sequentially, and
18011@code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
18012So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
18013@code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
18014@code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
18015is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
18016correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
18017means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
18018
18019
18020@node SOUP
18021@subsection SOUP
18022@cindex SOUP
18023@cindex offline
18024
18025In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
18026are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
18027With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
18028
18029Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
18030@code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
18031transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
18032newsreaders.
18033
18034However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
18035easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
18036that interested in doing things properly.
18037
18038A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
18039and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
18040fiddly.
18041
18042First some terminology:
18043
18044@table @dfn
18045
18046@item server
18047This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
18048get news and/or mail from.
18049
18050@item home machine
18051This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
18052on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
18053
18054@item packet
18055Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
18056of packets:
18057
18058@table @dfn
18059@item message packets
18060These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
18061messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
18062default, where @var{x} is a number.
18063
18064@item response packets
18065These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
18066replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
18067default, where @var{x} is a number.
18068
18069@end table
18070
18071@end table
18072
18073
18074@enumerate
18075
18076@item
18077You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
18078use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
18079can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
18080s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
18081
18082@item
18083You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
18084
18085@item
18086You put the packet in your home directory.
18087
18088@item
18089You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
18090the native or secondary server.
18091
18092@item
18093You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
18094want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
18095
18096@item
18097You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
18098packet.
18099
18100@item
18101You transfer this packet to the server.
18102
18103@item
18104You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
18105
18106@item
18107You then repeat until you die.
18108
18109@end enumerate
18110
18111So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
18112reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
18113
18114@menu
18115* SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
18116* SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
18117* SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
18118@end menu
18119
18120
18121@node SOUP Commands
18122@subsubsection SOUP Commands
18123
18124These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
18125
18126@table @kbd
18127@item G s b
18128@kindex G s b (Group)
18129@findex gnus-group-brew-soup
18130Pack all unread articles in the current group
18131(@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
18132process/prefix convention.
18133
18134@item G s w
18135@kindex G s w (Group)
18136@findex gnus-soup-save-areas
18137Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
18138
18139@item G s s
18140@kindex G s s (Group)
18141@findex gnus-soup-send-replies
18142Send all replies from the replies packet
18143(@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
18144
18145@item G s p
18146@kindex G s p (Group)
18147@findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
18148Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
18149
18150@item G s r
18151@kindex G s r (Group)
18152@findex nnsoup-pack-replies
18153Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
18154
18155@item O s
18156@kindex O s (Summary)
18157@findex gnus-soup-add-article
18158This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
18159(@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
18160convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18161
18162@end table
18163
18164
18165There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
18166thingies:
18167
18168@table @code
18169
18170@item gnus-soup-directory
18171@vindex gnus-soup-directory
18172Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
18173@sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
18174
18175@item gnus-soup-replies-directory
18176@vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
18177This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
18178reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
18179
18180@item gnus-soup-prefix-file
18181@vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
18182Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
18183@samp{gnus-prefix}.
18184
18185@item gnus-soup-packer
18186@vindex gnus-soup-packer
18187A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
18188@samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
18189
18190@item gnus-soup-unpacker
18191@vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
18192Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
18193@samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
18194
18195@item gnus-soup-packet-directory
18196@vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
18197Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
18198
18199@item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
18200@vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
18201Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
18202@code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
18203
18204@end table
18205
18206
18207@node SOUP Groups
18208@subsubsection SOUP Groups
18209@cindex nnsoup
18210
18211@code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
18212read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
18213you can read them at leisure.
18214
18215These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
18216
18217@table @code
18218
18219@item nnsoup-tmp-directory
18220@vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
18221When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
18222directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
18223
18224@item nnsoup-directory
18225@vindex nnsoup-directory
18226@code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
18227The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
18228
18229@item nnsoup-replies-directory
18230@vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
18231All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
18232reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/}.
18233
18234@item nnsoup-replies-format-type
18235@vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
18236The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
18237(rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
18238shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
18239
18240@item nnsoup-replies-index-type
18241@vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
18242The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
18243means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
18244
18245@item nnsoup-active-file
18246@vindex nnsoup-active-file
18247Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
18248file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
18249this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
18250@file{~/SOUP/active}.
18251
18252@item nnsoup-packer
18253@vindex nnsoup-packer
18254Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
18255is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
18256
18257@item nnsoup-unpacker
18258@vindex nnsoup-unpacker
18259Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
18260default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
18261
18262@item nnsoup-packet-directory
18263@vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
18264Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
18265@file{~/}.
18266
18267@item nnsoup-packet-regexp
18268@vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
18269Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
18270@samp{Soupout}.
18271
18272@item nnsoup-always-save
18273@vindex nnsoup-always-save
18274If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
18275
18276@end table
18277
18278
18279@node SOUP Replies
18280@subsubsection SOUP Replies
18281
18282Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
18283up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
18284more for that to happen.
18285
18286@findex nnsoup-set-variables
18287The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
18288variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
18289@sc{soup} system.
18290
18291In specific, this is what it does:
18292
18293@lisp
18294(setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
18295(setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
18296@end lisp
18297
18298And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
18299system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
18300@sc{soup}ed you use the second.
18301
18302
18303@node Mail-To-News Gateways
18304@subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
18305@cindex mail-to-news gateways
18306@cindex gateways
18307
18308If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
18309or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
18310The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
18311
18312Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
18313used to post with.
18314
18315Server variables:
18316
18317@table @code
18318@item nngateway-address
18319@vindex nngateway-address
18320This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
18321
18322@item nngateway-header-transformation
18323@vindex nngateway-header-transformation
18324News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
18325for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
18326transformation should be called, and defaults to
18327@code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
18328narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
18329gateway address.
18330
18331This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
18332@code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
18333For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
18334
18335@example
18336Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
18337@end example
18338
18339will get this @code{To} header inserted:
18340
18341@example
18342To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
18343@end example
18344
18345The following pre-defined functions exist:
18346
18347@findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
18348@table @code
18349
18350@item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
18351Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
18352@var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
18353
18354@findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
18355
18356@item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
18357Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
18358@code{nngateway-address}.
18359@end table
18360
18361@end table
18362
18363Here's an example:
18364
18365@lisp
18366(setq gnus-post-method
18367 '(nngateway
18368 "mail2news@@replay.com"
18369 (nngateway-header-transformation
18370 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
18371@end lisp
18372
18373So, to use this, simply say something like:
18374
18375@lisp
18376(setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
18377@end lisp
18378
18379
18380
18381@node Combined Groups
18382@section Combined Groups
18383
18384Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
18385groups.
18386
18387@menu
18388* Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
18389* Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
18390@end menu
18391
18392
18393@node Virtual Groups
18394@subsection Virtual Groups
18395@cindex nnvirtual
18396@cindex virtual groups
18397@cindex merging groups
18398
18399An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
18400other groups.
18401
18402For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
18403put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
18404big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
18405
18406You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
18407regexp to match component groups.
18408
18409All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
18410component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
18411article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
18412came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
18413shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
18414@kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
18415and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
18416(@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
18417
18418Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
18419newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
18420
18421@lisp
18422(nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
18423@end lisp
18424
18425The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
18426smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
18427
18428Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
18429idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
18430If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
18431and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
18432
18433@example
18434"^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
18435@end example
18436
18437(Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
18438shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
18439characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
18440
18441This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
18442end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
18443the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
18444sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
18445(@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
18446
18447One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
18448group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
18449zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
18450
18451@vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
18452If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
18453is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
18454articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
18455and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
18456been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
18457when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
18458have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
18459that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
18460just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
18461it---it'll have much the same effect.
18462
18463@code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
18464When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
18465has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
18466whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
18467there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
18468and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
18469not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
18470
18471@kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
18472line from the article you respond to in these cases.
18473
18474@code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
18475from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
18476inherited.
18477
18478
18479@node Kibozed Groups
18480@subsection Kibozed Groups
18481@cindex nnkiboze
18482@cindex kibozing
18483
18484@dfn{Kibozing} is defined by the @acronym{OED} as ``grepping through
18485(parts of) the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will
18486do this for you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @acronym{NNTP} server
18487down to a halt with useless requests! Oh happiness!
18488
18489@kindex G k (Group)
18490To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
18491buffer.
18492
18493The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
18494@code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
18495@code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between
18496@code{nnkiboze} and @code{nnvirtual} end.
18497
18498In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an
18499@code{nnkiboze} group must have a score file to say what articles are
18500to be included in the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
18501
18502@kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
18503@findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
18504You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
18505@code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time.
18506Lots of time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the
18507headers from all the articles in all the component groups and run them
18508through the scoring process to determine if there are any articles in
18509the groups that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
18510
18511Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
18512regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
18513@acronym{NNTP} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
18514Stranger things have happened.
18515
18516@code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
18517and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
18518
18519@vindex nnkiboze-directory
18520The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
18521@code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/kiboze/} by default.
18522One contains the @acronym{NOV} header lines for all the articles in
18523the group, and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store
18524information on what groups have been searched through to find
18525component articles.
18526
18527Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
18528their @acronym{NOV} lines removed from the @acronym{NOV} file.
18529
18530
18531@node Email Based Diary
18532@section Email Based Diary
18533@cindex diary
18534@cindex email based diary
18535@cindex calendar
18536
18537This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
18538and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
18539sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
18540reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
18541Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
18542namely, as event reminders.
18543
18544Here is a typical scenario:
18545
18546@itemize @bullet
18547@item
18548You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
18549to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
18550@item
18551So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
18552@item
18553You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
18554@item
18555From time to time, as you type `g' in the group buffer and as the date
18556is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
18557appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
18558@item
18559Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
18560of the night you're gonna have.
18561@item
18562Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
18563message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
18564@end itemize
18565
18566The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
18567(that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
18568real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
18569explained in the sections below.
18570
18571@menu
18572* The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
18573* The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
18574* Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
18575@end menu
18576
18577
18578@node The NNDiary Back End
18579@subsection The NNDiary Back End
18580@cindex nndiary
18581@cindex the nndiary back end
18582
18583@code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
18584Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
18585@code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
18586the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
18587directory per group.
18588
18589 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
18590@code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
18591of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
18592Timestamp} to see how it's done.
18593
18594@menu
18595* Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
18596* Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
18597* Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
18598@end menu
18599
18600@node Diary Messages
18601@subsubsection Diary Messages
18602@cindex nndiary messages
18603@cindex nndiary mails
18604
18605@code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
18606presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
18607@code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
18608@code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
18609@code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
18610@code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
18611crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
18612
18613@itemize @bullet
18614@item
18615For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
18616either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
18617(separated by a comma).
18618@item
18619A field is either an integer, or a range.
18620@item
18621A range is two integers separated by a dash.
18622@item
18623Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
18624@code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
18625for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
18626@item
18627As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
18628mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
18629that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
18630@item
18631The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
18632value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
18633values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
18634zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
18635list of available time zone values, see the variable
18636@code{nndiary-headers}.
18637@end itemize
18638
18639As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
18640for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
1864121:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
18642what to do then):
18643
18644@example
18645X-Diary-Minute: 0
18646X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
18647X-Diary-Dom: 1
18648X-Diary-Month: *
18649X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
18650X-Diary-Dow: 1
18651X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
18652@end example
18653
18654@node Running NNDiary
18655@subsubsection Running NNDiary
18656@cindex running nndiary
18657@cindex nndiary operation modes
18658
18659@code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
18660and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
18661mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
18662from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
18663as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
18664mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
18665
18666One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
18667``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
18668sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
18669messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
18670being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
18671the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
18672(which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
18673mode.
18674
18675In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
18676things to do:
18677
18678@itemize @bullet
18679@item
18680Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
18681line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
18682
18683@lisp
18684(setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
18685@end lisp
18686@item
18687You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
18688headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
18689Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
18690multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
18691source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
18692
18693As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
18694@file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
18695
18696@example
18697:0 HD :
18698* ^X-Diary
18699.nndiary
18700@end example
18701@end itemize
18702
18703Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
18704that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
18705
18706@defvar nndiary-mail-sources
18707This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
18708@code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
18709@code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
18710@end defvar
18711
18712@defvar nndiary-split-methods
18713This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
18714@code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
18715@end defvar
18716
18717 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
18718(something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
18719@code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
18720
18721 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
18722@file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
18723autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
18724also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
18725diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
18726
18727@node Customizing NNDiary
18728@subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
18729@cindex customizing nndiary
18730@cindex nndiary customization
18731
18732Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
18733The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
18734browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
18735two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
18736
18737@defvar nndiary-reminders
18738This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
18739appointments (e.g. 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
18740before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
18741diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
18742mail.
18743@end defvar
18744
18745@defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
18746Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
18747default).
18748@end defvar
18749
18750
18751@node The Gnus Diary Library
18752@subsection The Gnus Diary Library
18753@cindex gnus-diary
18754@cindex the gnus diary library
18755
18756Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
18757so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
18758@code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
18759useful things for you.
18760
18761 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
18762
18763@lisp
18764(require 'gnus-diary)
18765@end lisp
18766
18767 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
18768(@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
18769(sorry if you used them before).
18770
18771
18772@menu
18773* Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
18774* Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
18775* Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
18776* Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
18777@end menu
18778
18779@node Diary Summary Line Format
18780@subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
18781@cindex diary summary buffer line
18782@cindex diary summary line format
18783
18784Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
18785something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
18786the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
18787see the event's date.
18788
18789 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
18790summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
18791for the next occurrence of the event (e.g. ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
18792while @code{d} corresponds to an approximative remaining time until the
18793next occurrence of the event (e.g. ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
18794
18795 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
18796@code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
18797expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
18798
18799@example
18800 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
18801@end example
18802
18803In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
18804following line to your diary groups'parameters:
18805
18806@lisp
18807(gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
18808@end lisp
18809
18810However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
18811Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
18812with the following user options:
18813
18814@defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
18815Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
18816Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
18817diary groups'parameters.
18818@end defvar
18819
18820@defvar gnus-diary-time-format
18821Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
18822used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
18823@end defvar
18824
18825@defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
18826Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
18827times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
18828format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
18829you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
18830@end defvar
18831
18832@node Diary Articles Sorting
18833@subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
18834@cindex diary articles sorting
18835@cindex diary summary lines sorting
18836@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
18837@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
18838@findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
18839
18840@code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
18841Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
18842@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
18843@code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
18844your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
18845
18846@code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
18847@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
18848buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
18849default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
18850Parameters}).
18851
18852@node Diary Headers Generation
18853@subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
18854@cindex diary headers generation
18855@findex gnus-diary-check-message
18856
18857@code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
18858@code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
18859headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
18860required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
18861needed.
18862
18863 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
18864moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
18865automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c D c} in @code{message-mode}
18866and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the process of converting
18867a usual mail to a diary one.
18868
18869 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
18870all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
18871you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
18872instance.
18873
18874@node Diary Group Parameters
18875@subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
18876@cindex diary group parameters
18877
18878When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
18879automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
18880summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
18881diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
18882@code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
18883to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
18884on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
18885automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
18886
18887@node Sending or Not Sending
18888@subsection Sending or Not Sending
18889
18890Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
18891mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
18892
18893@itemize @bullet
18894@item
18895@code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
18896messsages for real. This means for instance that you can give
18897appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
18898sending the diary message to them as well.
18899@item
18900However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
18901can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
18902message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
18903comes in very handy for private appointments.
18904@end itemize
18905
18906@node Gnus Unplugged
18907@section Gnus Unplugged
18908@cindex offline
18909@cindex unplugged
18910@cindex agent
18911@cindex Gnus agent
18912@cindex Gnus unplugged
18913
18914In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
18915on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
18916was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
18917read news. Believe it or not.
18918
18919Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
18920modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
18921would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
18922the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
18923have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
18924
18925Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
18926@code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
18927for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
18928functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
18929reading news on a machine.
18930
18931Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
01c52d31
MB
18932fact, you don't have to configure anything as the agent is now enabled
18933by default (@pxref{Agent Variables, gnus-agent}).
4009494e
GM
18934
18935Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
18936
18937@menu
18938* Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
18939* Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
18940* Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
18941* Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
18942* Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
18943* Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
18944* Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
01c52d31 18945* Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
4009494e
GM
18946* Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
18947* Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
18948* Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
18949* Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
18950* Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
18951* Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
18952@end menu
18953
18954
18955@node Agent Basics
18956@subsection Agent Basics
18957
18958First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
18959
18960The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
18961connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
18962When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
18963Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
18964
18965The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
18966connected to the net continuously.
18967
18968@dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
18969machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
18970
18971You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
18972shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
18973is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
18974say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
18975you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
18976
18977Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
18978that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
18979can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
18980servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
18981they're kinda like plugged always).
18982
18983So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
18984connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
18985servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
18986the culprit.
18987
18988Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
18989reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
18990server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
18991server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
18992will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
18993
18994Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
18995
18996@itemize @bullet
18997
18998@item
18999@findex gnus-unplugged
19000You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
19001Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
19002already fetched while in this mode.
19003
19004@item
19005You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
19006your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
19007to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
19008as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
19009Source Specifiers}).
19010
19011@item
19012You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
19013news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
19014@kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
19015all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
19016articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
19017
19018@item
19019After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
19020unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
19021then you read the news offline.
19022
19023@item
19024And then you go to step 2.
19025@end itemize
19026
19027Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
19028the Agent.
19029
19030@itemize @bullet
19031
19032@item
19033Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
19034back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
19035Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
19036@kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
19037Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
19038added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
19039all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
19040@code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
19041
19042@item
19043Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
19044you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
19045parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
19046is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
19047
19048Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
19049(@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
19050to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
19051parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
19052to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
19053your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
19054configure them.
19055
19056@item
19057Uhm@dots{} that's it.
19058@end itemize
19059
19060
19061@node Agent Categories
19062@subsection Agent Categories
19063
19064One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
19065newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
19066There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
19067find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
19068to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
19069mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
19070you're interested in the articles anyway.
19071
19072One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
19073downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
19074groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
19075category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
19076buffer for creating and managing categories.
19077
19078If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
19079Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
19080alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
19081difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
19082less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
19083sink.
19084
19085Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
19086a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
19087the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
19088parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
19089variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
19090of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
19091your settings.
19092
19093@menu
19094* Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
19095* Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
19096* Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
19097@end menu
19098
19099
19100@node Category Syntax
19101@subsubsection Category Syntax
19102
19103A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
19104category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
19105customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
19106listed below.
19107
19108@cindex Agent Parameters
19109@table @code
01c52d31 19110@item agent-groups
4009494e
GM
19111The list of groups that are in this category.
19112
01c52d31 19113@item agent-predicate
4009494e
GM
19114A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
19115are eligible for downloading; and
19116
01c52d31 19117@item agent-score
4009494e
GM
19118a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
19119deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
19120score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
19121
01c52d31 19122@item agent-enable-expiration
4009494e
GM
19123a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
19124this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
19125fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
19126only groups that should not be expired.
19127
01c52d31 19128@item agent-days-until-old
4009494e
GM
19129an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
19130before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
19131
01c52d31 19132@item agent-low-score
4009494e
GM
19133an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
19134
01c52d31 19135@item agent-high-score
4009494e
GM
19136an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
19137
01c52d31 19138@item agent-short-article
4009494e
GM
19139an integer that overrides the value of
19140@code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
19141
01c52d31 19142@item agent-long-article
4009494e
GM
19143an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
19144
01c52d31 19145@item agent-enable-undownloaded-faces
4009494e 19146a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
01c52d31
MB
19147undownloaded articles using the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face}
19148faces. Any symbol other than @code{nil} will enable the use of
19149undownloaded faces.
4009494e
GM
19150@end table
19151
19152The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
19153created.
19154
19155Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
19156that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
19157group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
19158category.
19159
19160A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
19161@code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
19162article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
19163predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
19164
19165Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
19166their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
19167@code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
19168
19169To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
19170download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
19171operators sprinkled in between.
19172
19173Perhaps some examples are in order.
19174
19175Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
19176for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
19177
19178@lisp
19179short
19180@end lisp
19181
19182Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
19183short (for some value of ``short'').
19184
19185Here's a more complex predicate:
19186
19187@lisp
19188(or high
19189 (and
19190 (not low)
19191 (not long)))
19192@end lisp
19193
19194This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
19195or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
19196drift.
19197
19198The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
19199@code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
19200@samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
19201
19202The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
19203you want to do, you can write your own.
19204
19205When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
19206bound to the value determined by calling
19207@code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
19208example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
19209@code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
19210means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
19211predicate to individual groups.
19212
19213@table @code
19214@item short
19215True if the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
19216lines; default 100.
19217
19218@item long
19219True if the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
19220lines; default 200.
19221
19222@item low
19223True if the article has a download score less than
19224@code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
19225
19226@item high
19227True if the article has a download score greater than
19228@code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
19229
19230@item spam
19231True if the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
19232heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
19233checksum and sees whether articles match.
19234
19235@item true
19236Always true.
19237
19238@item false
19239Always false.
19240@end table
19241
19242If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
19243to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
19244@code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
19245useful values.
19246
19247For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
19248that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
19249more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
19250something along the lines of the following:
19251
19252@lisp
19253(defun my-article-old-p ()
19254 "Say whether an article is old."
19255 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
19256 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
19257@end lisp
19258
19259with the predicate then defined as:
19260
19261@lisp
19262(not my-article-old-p)
19263@end lisp
19264
19265or you could append your predicate to the predefined
19266@code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
19267wherever.
19268
19269@lisp
19270(require 'gnus-agent)
19271(setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
19272 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
19273 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
19274@end lisp
19275
19276and simply specify your predicate as:
19277
19278@lisp
19279(not old)
19280@end lisp
19281
19282If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
19283misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
19284always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
19285just don't give a damn.
19286
19287The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
19288category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
19289individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
19290new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
19291parameters like so:
19292
19293@lisp
19294(agent-predicate . short)
19295@end lisp
19296
19297This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
19298Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
19299@code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
19300
19301The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
19302
19303@lisp
19304(agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
19305@end lisp
19306
19307The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
19308entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
19309predicate is assumed to be a list.
19310
19311
19312Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
19313normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
19314seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
19315following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
19316@code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
19317@code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
19318
19319As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
19320to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
19321it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
19322if it's to be specific to that group.
19323
19324In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
19325three forms:
19326
19327@enumerate
19328@item
19329Score rule
19330
19331This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
19332subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
19333
19334example:
19335
19336@itemize @bullet
19337@item
19338Category specification
19339
19340@lisp
19341(("from"
19342 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
19343("lines"
19344 (500 -100 nil <)))
19345@end lisp
19346
19347@item
19348Group/Topic Parameter specification
19349
19350@lisp
19351(agent-score ("from"
19352 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
19353 ("lines"
19354 (500 -100 nil <)))
19355@end lisp
19356
19357Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
19358@end itemize
19359
19360@item
19361Agent score file
19362
19363These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
19364keywords stated above.
19365
19366example:
19367
19368@itemize @bullet
19369@item
19370Category specification
19371
19372@lisp
19373("~/News/agent.SCORE")
19374@end lisp
19375
19376or perhaps
19377
19378@lisp
19379("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
19380@end lisp
19381
19382@item
19383Group Parameter specification
19384
19385@lisp
19386(agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
19387@end lisp
19388
19389Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
19390about parenthesis?
19391@end itemize
19392
19393@item
19394Use @code{normal} score files
19395
19396If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
19397your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
19398@code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
19399@code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
19400
19401These directives in either the category definition or a group's
19402parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
19403files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
19404relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
19405
19406@itemize @bullet
19407@item
19408Category Specification
19409
19410@lisp
19411file
19412@end lisp
19413
19414@item
19415Group Parameter specification
19416
19417@lisp
19418(agent-score . file)
19419@end lisp
19420@end itemize
19421@end enumerate
19422
19423@node Category Buffer
19424@subsubsection Category Buffer
19425
19426You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
19427When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
19428the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
19429
19430The following commands are available in this buffer:
19431
19432@table @kbd
19433@item q
19434@kindex q (Category)
19435@findex gnus-category-exit
19436Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
19437
19438@item e
19439@kindex e (Category)
19440@findex gnus-category-customize-category
19441Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
19442parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
19443
19444@item k
19445@kindex k (Category)
19446@findex gnus-category-kill
19447Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
19448
19449@item c
19450@kindex c (Category)
19451@findex gnus-category-copy
19452Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
19453
19454@item a
19455@kindex a (Category)
19456@findex gnus-category-add
19457Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
19458
19459@item p
19460@kindex p (Category)
19461@findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
19462Edit the predicate of the current category
19463(@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
19464
19465@item g
19466@kindex g (Category)
19467@findex gnus-category-edit-groups
19468Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
19469(@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
19470
19471@item s
19472@kindex s (Category)
19473@findex gnus-category-edit-score
19474Edit the download score rule of the current category
19475(@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
19476
19477@item l
19478@kindex l (Category)
19479@findex gnus-category-list
19480List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
19481@end table
19482
19483
19484@node Category Variables
19485@subsubsection Category Variables
19486
19487@table @code
19488@item gnus-category-mode-hook
19489@vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
19490Hook run in category buffers.
19491
19492@item gnus-category-line-format
19493@vindex gnus-category-line-format
19494Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
19495Variables}). Valid elements are:
19496
19497@table @samp
19498@item c
19499The name of the category.
19500
19501@item g
19502The number of groups in the category.
19503@end table
19504
19505@item gnus-category-mode-line-format
19506@vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
19507Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
19508
19509@item gnus-agent-short-article
19510@vindex gnus-agent-short-article
19511Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
19512
19513@item gnus-agent-long-article
19514@vindex gnus-agent-long-article
19515Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
19516
19517@item gnus-agent-low-score
19518@vindex gnus-agent-low-score
19519Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
195200.
19521
19522@item gnus-agent-high-score
19523@vindex gnus-agent-high-score
19524Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
195250.
19526
19527@item gnus-agent-expire-days
19528@vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
19529The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
19530local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
19531the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
19532just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
19533important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
19534article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
19535read.
19536Default 7.
19537
19538@item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
19539@vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
19540Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
19541retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
19542you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
19543you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
19544have to enable expiration in selected groups.
19545
19546@end table
19547
19548
19549@node Agent Commands
19550@subsection Agent Commands
19551@findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
19552@kindex J j (Agent)
19553
19554All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
19555(@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
19556toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
19557
19558
19559@menu
19560* Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
19561* Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
19562* Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
19563@end menu
19564
19565
19566
19567
19568@node Group Agent Commands
19569@subsubsection Group Agent Commands
19570
19571@table @kbd
19572@item J u
19573@kindex J u (Agent Group)
19574@findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
19575Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
19576(@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
19577
19578@item J c
19579@kindex J c (Agent Group)
19580@findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
19581Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
19582
19583@item J s
19584@kindex J s (Agent Group)
19585@findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
19586Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
19587(@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
19588
19589@item J S
19590@kindex J S (Agent Group)
19591@findex gnus-group-send-queue
19592Send all sendable messages in the queue group
19593(@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
19594
19595@item J a
19596@kindex J a (Agent Group)
19597@findex gnus-agent-add-group
19598Add the current group to an Agent category
19599(@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
19600process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
19601
19602@item J r
19603@kindex J r (Agent Group)
19604@findex gnus-agent-remove-group
19605Remove the current group from its category, if any
19606(@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
19607process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
19608
19609@item J Y
19610@kindex J Y (Agent Group)
19611@findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19612Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
19613
19614
19615@end table
19616
19617
19618@node Summary Agent Commands
19619@subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
19620
19621@table @kbd
19622@item J #
19623@kindex J # (Agent Summary)
19624@findex gnus-agent-mark-article
19625Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
19626
19627@item J M-#
19628@kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
19629@findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
19630Remove the downloading mark from the article
19631(@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
19632
19633@cindex %
19634@item @@
19635@kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
19636@findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
19637Toggle whether to download the article
19638(@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
19639default.
19640
19641@item J c
19642@kindex J c (Agent Summary)
19643@findex gnus-agent-catchup
19644Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
19645
19646@item J S
19647@kindex J S (Agent Summary)
19648@findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
19649Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
19650(@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
19651
19652@item J s
19653@kindex J s (Agent Summary)
01c52d31 19654@findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series
4009494e 19655Download all processable articles in this group.
01c52d31 19656(@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series}).
4009494e
GM
19657
19658@item J u
19659@kindex J u (Agent Summary)
19660@findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
19661Download all downloadable articles in the current group
19662(@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
19663
19664@end table
19665
19666
19667@node Server Agent Commands
19668@subsubsection Server Agent Commands
19669
19670@table @kbd
19671@item J a
19672@kindex J a (Agent Server)
19673@findex gnus-agent-add-server
19674Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
19675(@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
19676
19677@item J r
19678@kindex J r (Agent Server)
19679@findex gnus-agent-remove-server
19680Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
19681Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
19682
19683@end table
19684
19685
19686@node Agent Visuals
19687@subsection Agent Visuals
19688
19689If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
19690active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
19691stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
19692something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
19693placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
19694there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
19695When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
19696placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
19697You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
19698placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
19699
19700While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
19701available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
19702fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
19703way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
19704less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
19705adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
19706the download status of each article so that you always know which
19707articles will be available when unplugged.
19708
19709The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
19710@code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
19711a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
19712Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
19713will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
19714other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
19715@samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
19716(@samp{ }) will be displayed.
19717
19718The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
19719are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
19720result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
19721that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
19722face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
19723tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
19724conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
19725that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
19726to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
19727
19728If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
19729each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
19730undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
19731being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
01c52d31
MB
19732downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear. For those
19733users using the agent to improve online performance by caching the NOV
19734database (most users since 5.10.2), the undownloaded faces may appear
19735to be an absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since none
19736of their articles have been fetched into the Agent, all of the
19737normal faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces.
19738
19739If you would like to use the undownloaded faces, you must enable the
19740undownloaded faces by setting the @code{agent-enable-undownloaded-faces}
19741group parameter to @code{t}. This parameter, like all other agent
19742parameters, may be set on an Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}),
19743a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic Parameters}), or an individual group
19744(@pxref{Group Parameters}).
19745
19746The one problem common to all users using the agent is how quickly it
19747can consume disk space. If you using the agent on many groups, it is
19748even more difficult to effectively recover disk space. One solution
19749is the @samp{%F} format available in @code{gnus-group-line-format}.
19750This format will display the actual disk space used by articles
19751fetched into both the agent and cache. By knowing which groups use
19752the most space, users know where to focus their efforts when ``agent
19753expiring'' articles.
4009494e
GM
19754
19755@node Agent as Cache
19756@subsection Agent as Cache
19757
19758When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
19759articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
19760Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
19761in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
19762buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
19763are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
19764consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
19765article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
19766server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
19767
19768If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
19769@pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
19770plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
19771synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
19772sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
19773
19774@node Agent Expiry
19775@subsection Agent Expiry
19776
19777@vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
19778@findex gnus-agent-expire
19779@kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
19780@kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
19781@findex gnus-agent-expire-group
19782@cindex agent expiry
19783@cindex Gnus agent expiry
19784@cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
19785
19786The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
19787least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
19788special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
19789commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
19790@code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
19791that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
19792efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
19793@kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
19794
19795Note that other functions, e.g. @code{gnus-request-expire-articles},
19796might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you to keep the agent
19797synchronized with the group.
19798
19799The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
19800prevent expiration in selected groups.
19801
19802@vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
19803If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
19804expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
19805and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
19806are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
19807be kept indefinitely.
19808
19809If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
19810perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
19811commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
19812@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
19813
19814@node Agent Regeneration
19815@subsection Agent Regeneration
19816
19817@cindex agent regeneration
19818@cindex Gnus agent regeneration
19819@cindex regeneration
19820
19821The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
19822due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
19823@code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
19824to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
19825internal inconsistencies.
19826
19827For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
19828downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
19829know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
19830failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
19831@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
19832such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
19833
19834@findex gnus-agent-regenerate
19835@kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
19836The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
19837@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
19838you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
19839recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
19840
19841@findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19842@kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19843The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
19844of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
19845then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
19846are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
19847agent as unread.
19848
01c52d31
MB
19849@node Agent and flags
19850@subsection Agent and flags
4009494e 19851
01c52d31
MB
19852The Agent works with any Gnus back end including those, such as
19853nnimap, that store flags (read, ticked, etc) on the server. Sadly,
19854the Agent does not actually know which backends keep their flags in
19855the backend server rather than in @file{.newsrc}. This means that the
19856Agent, while unplugged or disconnected, will always record all changes
19857to the flags in its own files.
4009494e 19858
01c52d31
MB
19859When you plug back in, Gnus will then check to see if you have any
19860changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the
19861server. This behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
4009494e
GM
19862
19863@vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19864If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19865never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19866the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19867ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19868any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19869
19870If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
19871re-connect, you can do it manually with the
19872@code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
19873in the group buffer.
19874
01c52d31
MB
19875Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
19876all local flags to the server, but rather by incrementally updated the
19877server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
19878the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group then
19879re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
19880removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
19881operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
19882directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
19883
19884@node Agent and IMAP
19885@subsection Agent and IMAP
19886
19887The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
19888since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
19889@acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
19890make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
19891
4009494e
GM
19892Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
19893expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
19894
19895@itemize @bullet
19896
19897@item
19898Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
19899
19900@item
19901Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
19902
19903@end itemize
19904
4009494e
GM
19905@node Outgoing Messages
19906@subsection Outgoing Messages
19907
01c52d31
MB
19908By default, when Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail
19909and news) are stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}).
19910You can view them there after posting, and edit them at will.
4009494e 19911
01c52d31
MB
19912You can control the circumstances under which outgoing mail is queued
19913(see @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail}, @pxref{Agent Variables}). Outgoing
19914news is always queued when Gnus is unplugged, and never otherwise.
4009494e 19915
01c52d31
MB
19916You can send the messages either from the draft group with the special
19917commands available there, or you can use the @kbd{J S} command in the
19918group buffer to send all the sendable messages in the draft group.
19919Posting news will only work when Gnus is plugged, but you can send
19920mail at any time.
4009494e 19921
01c52d31
MB
19922If sending mail while unplugged does not work for you and you worry
19923about hitting @kbd{J S} by accident when unplugged, you can have Gnus
19924ask you to confirm your action (see
19925@code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue}, @pxref{Agent Variables}).
4009494e
GM
19926
19927@node Agent Variables
19928@subsection Agent Variables
19929
19930@table @code
01c52d31
MB
19931@item gnus-agent
19932@vindex gnus-agent
19933Is the agent enabled? The default is @code{t}. When first enabled,
19934the agent will use @code{gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods} to
19935automatically mark some back ends as agentized. You may change which
19936back ends are agentized using the agent commands in the server buffer.
19937
19938To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
19939(@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
19940
19941
4009494e
GM
19942@item gnus-agent-directory
19943@vindex gnus-agent-directory
19944Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
19945@file{~/News/agent/}.
19946
19947@item gnus-agent-handle-level
19948@vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
19949Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
19950be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
19951which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
19952by default.
19953
19954@item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19955@vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19956Hook run when connecting to the network.
19957
19958@item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19959@vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19960Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
19961
19962@item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19963@vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19964Hook run when finished fetching articles.
19965
19966@item gnus-agent-cache
19967@vindex gnus-agent-cache
19968Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
19969articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
19970The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
19971
19972@item gnus-agent-go-online
19973@vindex gnus-agent-go-online
19974If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
19975automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
19976@code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
19977offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
19978other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
19979online status.
19980
19981@item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19982@vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19983If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
19984mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
19985thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
19986read. The default is @code{t}.
19987
01c52d31
MB
19988@item gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19989@vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19990If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19991never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19992the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19993ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19994any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19995
4009494e
GM
19996@item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19997@vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19998If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
19999agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
20000downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
20001the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
20002are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
20003into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
20004the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
20005over and over again.
20006
20007@item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
20008@vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
20009The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
20010them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
20011the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
20012have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
20013limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
20014performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
20015connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
20016@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
20017However, all articles parsed prior to loosing the connection will be
20018available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
20019see any cycling.
20020
20021@item gnus-server-unopen-status
20022@vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
20023Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
20024variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
20025Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
20026whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
20027Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
20028for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
20029is only valid if the Agent is used.
20030
20031@item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
20032@vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
20033Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
20034that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
20035buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
20036agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
20037
20038The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
20039@code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
20040have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
20041ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
20042(maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
20043
01c52d31
MB
20044@item gnus-agent-queue-mail
20045@vindex gnus-agent-queue-mail
20046When @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail} is @code{always}, Gnus will always
20047queue mail rather than sending it straight away. When @code{t}, Gnus
20048will queue mail when unplugged only. When @code{nil}, never queue
20049mail. The default is @code{t}.
20050
20051@item gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
20052@vindex gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
20053When @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue} is non-@code{nil} Gnus will
20054prompt you to confirm that you really wish to proceed if you hit
20055@kbd{J S} while unplugged. The default is @code{nil}.
20056
4009494e
GM
20057@item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
20058@vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
20059If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
20060@file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
20061automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
01c52d31
MB
20062which back ends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
20063to agentize remote back ends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
4009494e
GM
20064as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
20065If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
20066removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
20067start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
20068
20069@end table
20070
20071
20072@node Example Setup
20073@subsection Example Setup
20074
20075If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
20076setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
20077@file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
20078
20079@lisp
20080;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
20081;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
20082(setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
20083
20084;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
20085;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
20086(setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
20087
20088;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
20089(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
20090
20091;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
20092;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
20093;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
20094@end lisp
20095
20096That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
20097edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
20098gnus}.
20099
20100If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
20101automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
20102subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
20103@acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
20104command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
20105once.
20106
20107After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
20108groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
20109command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
20110subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
20111back all the killed groups.)
20112
20113You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
20114with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
20115find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
20116
20117
20118@node Batching Agents
20119@subsection Batching Agents
20120@findex gnus-agent-batch
20121
20122Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
20123written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
20124following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
20125
20126You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
20127following incantation:
20128
20129@example
20130#!/bin/sh
20131emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
20132@end example
20133
20134
20135@node Agent Caveats
20136@subsection Agent Caveats
20137
20138The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
20139newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
20140may ask:
20141
20142@table @dfn
20143@item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
20144
20145@strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
20146@code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
20147@code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
20148
20149@item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
20150the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
20151
20152@strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
20153
20154@end table
20155
20156In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
20157articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
20158locally stored articles.
20159
20160
20161@node Scoring
20162@chapter Scoring
20163@cindex scoring
20164
20165Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
20166scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
20167something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
20168attention!
20169
20170@vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
20171All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
20172which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
20173interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
20174@code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
20175
20176Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
20177before generating the summary buffer.
20178
20179There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
20180entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
20181lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
20182
20183There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
20184Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
20185temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
20186silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
20187
20188@menu
20189* Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
20190* Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
20191* Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
20192* Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
20193* Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
20194* Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
20195* Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
20196* Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
20197* Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
20198* Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
20199* Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
20200* Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
20201* Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
20202* Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
4009494e
GM
20203* Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
20204* Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
20205@end menu
20206
20207
20208@node Summary Score Commands
20209@section Summary Score Commands
20210@cindex score commands
20211
20212The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
20213score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
20214previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
20215@dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
20216entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
20217
20218The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
20219if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
20220some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
20221score file the current one.
20222
20223General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
20224
20225@table @kbd
20226
20227@item V s
20228@kindex V s (Summary)
20229@findex gnus-summary-set-score
20230Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
20231
20232@item V S
20233@kindex V S (Summary)
20234@findex gnus-summary-current-score
20235Display the score of the current article
20236(@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
20237
20238@item V t
20239@kindex V t (Summary)
20240@findex gnus-score-find-trace
20241Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
20242(@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
20243may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
20244current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
20245score file and edit it.
20246
20247@item V w
20248@kindex V w (Summary)
20249@findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
20250List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
20251
20252@item V R
20253@kindex V R (Summary)
20254@findex gnus-summary-rescore
20255Run the current summary through the scoring process
20256(@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
20257around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
20258effect you're having.
20259
20260@item V c
20261@kindex V c (Summary)
20262@findex gnus-score-change-score-file
20263Make a different score file the current
20264(@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
20265
20266@item V e
20267@kindex V e (Summary)
20268@findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
20269Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
20270You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
20271File Editing}).
20272
20273@item V f
20274@kindex V f (Summary)
20275@findex gnus-score-edit-file
20276Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
20277(@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
20278
20279@item V F
20280@kindex V F (Summary)
20281@findex gnus-score-flush-cache
20282Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
20283after editing score files.
20284
20285@item V C
20286@kindex V C (Summary)
20287@findex gnus-score-customize
20288Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
20289(@code{gnus-score-customize}).
20290
20291@end table
20292
20293The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
20294
20295@table @kbd
20296
20297@item V m
20298@kindex V m (Summary)
20299@findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
20300Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
20301read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
20302
20303@item V x
20304@kindex V x (Summary)
20305@findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
20306Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
20307expunge all articles below this score
20308(@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
20309@end table
20310
20311The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
20312pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
20313them.)
20314
20315@findex gnus-summary-increase-score
20316@findex gnus-summary-lower-score
20317
20318@enumerate
20319@item
20320The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
20321or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
20322@item
20323The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
20324keys are available:
20325@table @kbd
20326
20327@item a
20328Score on the author name.
20329
20330@item s
20331Score on the subject line.
20332
20333@item x
20334Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
20335
20336@item r
20337Score on the @code{References} line.
20338
20339@item d
20340Score on the date.
20341
20342@item l
20343Score on the number of lines.
20344
20345@item i
20346Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
20347
20348@item e
20349Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
20350if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
20351
20352@item f
20353Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
20354the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
20355@file{ADAPT} files.)
20356
20357@item b
20358Score on the body.
20359
20360@item h
20361Score on the head.
20362
20363@item t
20364Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
20365files.)
20366
20367@end table
20368
20369@item
20370The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
20371what headers you are scoring on.
20372
20373@table @code
20374
20375@item strings
20376
20377@table @kbd
20378
20379@item e
20380Exact matching.
20381
20382@item s
20383Substring matching.
20384
20385@item f
20386Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
20387
20388@item r
20389Regexp matching
20390@end table
20391
20392@item date
20393@table @kbd
20394
20395@item b
20396Before date.
20397
20398@item a
20399After date.
20400
20401@item n
20402This date.
20403@end table
20404
20405@item number
20406@table @kbd
20407
20408@item <
20409Less than number.
20410
20411@item =
20412Equal to number.
20413
20414@item >
20415Greater than number.
20416@end table
20417@end table
20418
20419@item
20420The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
20421expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
20422or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
20423file.
20424@table @kbd
20425
20426@item t
20427Temporary score entry.
20428
20429@item p
20430Permanent score entry.
20431
20432@item i
20433Immediately scoring.
20434@end table
20435
20436@item
20437If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
20438the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
20439in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
20440
20441@end enumerate
20442
20443So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
20444exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
20445score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
20446temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
20447
20448To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
20449a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
20450defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
20451``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
20452t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
20453
20454These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
20455(@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
20456(or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
20457says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
20458current score file.
20459
20460@vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
20461The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
20462pretend they are keymaps or not.
20463
20464
20465@node Group Score Commands
20466@section Group Score Commands
20467@cindex group score commands
20468
20469There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
20470
20471@table @kbd
20472
01c52d31
MB
20473@item W e
20474@kindex W e (Group)
20475@findex gnus-score-edit-all-score
20476Edit the apply-to-all-groups all.SCORE file. You will be popped into
20477a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score File Editing}).
20478
4009494e
GM
20479@item W f
20480@kindex W f (Group)
20481@findex gnus-score-flush-cache
20482Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
20483all the time. This command will flush the cache
20484(@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
20485
20486@end table
20487
20488You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
20489
20490@findex gnus-batch-score
20491@cindex batch scoring
20492@example
20493$ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
20494@end example
20495
20496
20497@node Score Variables
20498@section Score Variables
20499@cindex score variables
20500
20501@table @code
20502
20503@item gnus-use-scoring
20504@vindex gnus-use-scoring
20505If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
20506general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
20507
20508@item gnus-kill-killed
20509@vindex gnus-kill-killed
20510If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
20511articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
20512may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
20513to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
20514group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
20515variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
20516
20517@item gnus-kill-files-directory
20518@vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
20519All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
20520initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
20521This is @file{~/News/} by default.
20522
20523@item gnus-score-file-suffix
20524@vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
20525Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
20526(@file{SCORE} by default.)
20527
20528@item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
20529@vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
20530@cindex score cache
20531All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
bbbe940b 20532score files. However, this might make your Emacs grow big and
4009494e
GM
20533bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
20534to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
20535@file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
20536@file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
20537variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
20538be cached.
20539
20540@item gnus-save-score
20541@vindex gnus-save-score
20542If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
20543scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
20544Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
20545
20546If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
20547with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
20548across group visits.
20549
20550@item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
20551@vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
20552Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
20553score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
20554ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
20555We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
20556manually entered data.
20557
20558@item gnus-summary-default-score
20559@vindex gnus-summary-default-score
20560Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
20561
20562@item gnus-summary-expunge-below
20563@vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
20564Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
20565this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
20566articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
20567and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
20568
20569@item gnus-score-over-mark
20570@vindex gnus-score-over-mark
20571Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
20572default. Default is @samp{+}.
20573
20574@item gnus-score-below-mark
20575@vindex gnus-score-below-mark
20576Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
20577default. Default is @samp{-}.
20578
20579@item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
20580@vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
20581Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
20582is called with the name of the group as the argument.
20583
20584Predefined functions available are:
20585@table @code
20586
20587@item gnus-score-find-single
20588@findex gnus-score-find-single
20589Only apply the group's own score file.
20590
20591@item gnus-score-find-bnews
20592@findex gnus-score-find-bnews
20593Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
20594default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
20595@file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
20596@file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
20597@samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
20598then a regexp match is done.
20599
20600This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
20601all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
20602
20603The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
20604try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
20605files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
20606file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
20607
20608@item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
20609@findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
20610Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
20611can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
20612@file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
20613server.
20614
20615@end table
20616This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
20617these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
20618all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
20619functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
20620that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
20621should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
20622ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
20623Phu.
20624
20625For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
20626overall score file, you could use the value
20627@example
20628(list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
20629 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
20630@end example
20631
20632@item gnus-score-expiry-days
20633@vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
20634This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
20635entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
20636are expired. It's 7 by default.
20637
20638@item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
20639@vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
20640If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
20641been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
20642controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
20643matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
20644variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
20645have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
20646
20647@item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
20648@vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
20649Function called with the name of the score file just written.
20650
20651@item gnus-score-thread-simplify
20652@vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
20653If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
20654simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
20655threading---according to the current value of
20656@code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
20657@code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
20658simplified in this manner.
20659
20660@end table
20661
20662
20663@node Score File Format
20664@section Score File Format
20665@cindex score file format
20666
20667A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
20668single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
20669everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
20670
20671Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
20672
20673@lisp
20674(("from"
20675 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
20676 ("Per Abrahamsen")
20677 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
20678 ("subject"
20679 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
20680 ("xref"
20681 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
20682 ("lines"
20683 (2 -100 nil <))
20684 (mark 0)
20685 (expunge -1000)
20686 (mark-and-expunge -10)
20687 (read-only nil)
20688 (orphan -10)
20689 (adapt t)
20690 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
20691 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
20692 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
20693 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
20694 (eval (ding)))
20695@end lisp
20696
20697This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
20698Scoring}, for a different approach.
20699
20700Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
20701@code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
20702has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
20703
20704Six keys are supported by this alist:
20705
20706@table @code
20707
20708@item STRING
20709If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
20710match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
20711@code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
20712@code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
20713these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
20714article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
20715will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
20716perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
20717perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
20718last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
20719final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
20720entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
20721to articles that matches these score entries.
20722
20723Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
20724score entry has one to four elements.
20725@enumerate
20726
20727@item
20728The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
20729be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
20730integer.
20731
20732@item
20733If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
20734element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
20735interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
20736is successful. If this element is not present, the
20737@code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
20738instead. This is 1000 by default.
20739
20740@item
20741If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
20742element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
20743which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
20744element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
20745represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
20746
20747@item
20748If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
20749element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
20750whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
20751be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
20752@table @dfn
20753
20754@item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
20755For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
20756well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
20757@code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
20758element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
20759be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
20760that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
20761one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
20762@code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
20763instead, if you feel like.
20764
20765@item Extra
20766Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
20767gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
20768case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
20769header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
20770@file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
20771host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
20772overviews:
20773
20774@lisp
20775("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
20776 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
20777@end lisp
20778
20779@item Lines, Chars
20780These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
20781@code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
20782
20783These predicates are true if
20784
20785@example
20786(PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
20787@end example
20788
20789evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
20790@code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
20791following form:
20792
20793@lisp
20794(< header-value 4)
20795@end lisp
20796
20797Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
20798the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
20799(It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
20800it's not. I think.)
20801
20802When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
20803@code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
20804up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
20805you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
20806
20807@item Date
20808For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
20809@code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
20810ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
20811this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
20812Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
20813sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
20814quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
20815
20816@cindex ISO8601
20817@cindex date
20818A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
20819date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
20820ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
20821you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
20822every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
20823for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
20824this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
20825the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
20826whole family, eh?)
20827
20828@item Head, Body, All
20829These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
20830header uses.
20831
20832@item Followup
20833This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
20834@code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
20835articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
20836you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
20837decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
20838trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
20839uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
20840files.)
20841
20842@item Thread
20843This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
20844key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
20845article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
20846match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
20847has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
20848matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
20849This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
20850even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
20851@code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
20852undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
20853key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
20854@end table
20855@end enumerate
20856
20857@cindex score file atoms
20858@item mark
20859The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20860lower than this number will be marked as read.
20861
20862@item expunge
20863The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20864lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
20865
20866@item mark-and-expunge
20867The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20868lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
20869summary buffer.
20870
20871@item thread-mark-and-expunge
20872The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
20873a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
20874and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
20875says how to compute the total score for a thread.
20876
20877@item files
20878The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
20879are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
20880this one was.
20881
20882@item exclude-files
20883The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
20884not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
20885other.
20886
20887@item eval
20888The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
20889ignored when handling global score files.
20890
20891@item read-only
20892Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
20893should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
20894@dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
20895apply-to-all-groups score files.)
20896
20897@item orphan
20898The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
20899parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
20900some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
20901will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
20902
20903You can do this with the following two score file entries:
20904
20905@example
20906 (orphan -500)
20907 (mark-and-expunge -100)
20908@end example
20909
20910When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
20911threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
20912interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
20913rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
20914interesting threads, plus any new threads.
20915
20916I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
20917interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
20918scoring rules exist.
20919
20920@item adapt
20921This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
20922default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
20923adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
20924list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
20925or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
20926adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
20927scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20928@code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
20929not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
20930groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
20931insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
20932it.
20933
20934@item adapt-file
20935All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
20936will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
20937if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
20938file for a number of groups.
20939
20940@item local
20941@cindex local variables
20942The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
20943@var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
20944current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
20945convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
20946groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
20947be evaluated.
20948@end table
20949
20950
20951@node Score File Editing
20952@section Score File Editing
20953
20954You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
20955might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
20956with a mode for that.
20957
20958It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
20959additional commands:
20960
20961@table @kbd
20962
20963@item C-c C-c
20964@kindex C-c C-c (Score)
20965@findex gnus-score-edit-done
20966Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
20967(@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
20968
20969@item C-c C-d
20970@kindex C-c C-d (Score)
20971@findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
20972Insert the current date in numerical format
20973(@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
20974you were wondering.
20975
20976@item C-c C-p
20977@kindex C-c C-p (Score)
20978@findex gnus-score-pretty-print
20979The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
20980intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
20981first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
20982you.
20983
20984@end table
20985
20986Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
20987
20988@vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
20989@code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
20990
20991In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
20992@kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
20993
20994
20995@node Adaptive Scoring
20996@section Adaptive Scoring
20997@cindex adaptive scoring
20998
20999If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
21000happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
21001stupidity, to be precise.
21002
21003@vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
21004When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
21005article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
21006these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
21007You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
21008@code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
21009words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
21010@code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
21011variable to @code{(word line)}.
21012
21013@vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
21014To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
21015the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
21016might look something like this:
21017
21018@lisp
21019(setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
21020 '((gnus-unread-mark)
21021 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
21022 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
21023 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
21024 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
21025 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
21026 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
21027 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
21028 (gnus-ancient-mark)
21029 (gnus-low-score-mark)
21030 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
21031@end lisp
21032
21033As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
21034variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
21035a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
21036pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
21037that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
21038@code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
21039entries.
21040
21041Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
21042will be applied to each article.
21043
21044To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
21045articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
21046score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
21047lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
21048
21049If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
21050@code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
21051That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
21052should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
21053
21054If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
21055the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
21056probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
21057adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
21058
21059The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
21060@code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
21061@code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
21062@code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
21063on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
21064current article, thereby matching the following thread.
21065
21066If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
21067to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
21068changes result in articles getting marked as read.
21069
21070After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
21071become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
21072the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
21073
21074You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
21075by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
21076let you use different rules in different groups.
21077
21078@vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
21079The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
21080group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
21081is @file{ADAPT}.
21082
01c52d31
MB
21083@vindex gnus-adaptive-pretty-print
21084Adaptive score files can get huge and are not meant to be edited by
21085human hands. If @code{gnus-adaptive-pretty-print} is @code{nil} (the
21086deafult) those files will not be written in a human readable way.
21087
4009494e
GM
21088@vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
21089When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
21090give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
21091matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
21092the length of the match is less than
21093@code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
21094this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
21095this problem.
21096
21097@vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
21098As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
21099headers. If you adapt on words, the
21100@code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
21101each instance of a word should add given a mark.
21102
21103@lisp
21104(setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
21105 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
21106 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
21107 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
21108 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
21109@end lisp
21110
21111This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
21112word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
21113@code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
21114score with 30 points.
21115
21116@vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
21117@vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
21118Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
21119will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
21120@code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
21121
21122@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
21123Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
21124scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
21125an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
21126variable defaults to @code{nil}.
21127
21128@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
21129When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
21130syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
21131it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
21132
21133@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
21134If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
21135word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
21136below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
21137
21138@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
21139If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
21140won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
21141for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
21142lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
21143
21144After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
21145@code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
21146what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
21147
21148Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
21149likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
21150that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
21151rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
21152
21153
21154@node Home Score File
21155@section Home Score File
21156
21157The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
21158@dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
21159for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
21160@samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
21161
21162However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
21163a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
21164could perhaps use the same home score file.
21165
21166@vindex gnus-home-score-file
21167The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
21168be:
21169
21170@enumerate
21171@item
21172A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
21173groups.
21174
21175@item
21176A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
21177file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
21178parameter.
21179
21180@item
21181A list. The elements in this list can be:
21182
21183@enumerate
21184@item
21185@code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
21186group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
21187
21188@item
21189A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
21190be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
21191name of the group as the parameter.
21192
21193@item
21194A string. Use the string as the home score file.
21195@end enumerate
21196
21197The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
21198for matches.
21199
21200@end enumerate
21201
21202So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
21203
21204@lisp
21205(setq gnus-home-score-file
21206 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
21207@end lisp
21208
21209If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
21210@file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
21211
21212@findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
21213@lisp
21214(setq gnus-home-score-file
21215 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
21216@end lisp
21217
21218This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
21219Other functions include
21220
21221@table @code
21222@item gnus-current-home-score-file
21223@findex gnus-current-home-score-file
21224Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
21225commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
21226
21227@end table
21228
21229If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
21230another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
21231their own home score files:
21232
21233@lisp
21234(setq gnus-home-score-file
21235 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
21236 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
21237 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
21238 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
21239@end lisp
21240
21241@vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
21242@code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
21243@code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
21244is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
21245specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
21246
21247In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
21248@code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
21249(@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
21250Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
21251precedence over this variable.
21252
21253
21254@node Followups To Yourself
21255@section Followups To Yourself
21256
21257Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
21258the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
21259this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
21260articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
21261respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
21262to easily note when people answer what you've said.
21263
21264@table @code
21265
21266@item gnus-score-followup-article
21267@findex gnus-score-followup-article
21268This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
21269article.
21270
21271@item gnus-score-followup-thread
21272@findex gnus-score-followup-thread
21273This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
21274your own article.
21275@end table
21276
21277@vindex message-sent-hook
21278These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
21279@code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
21280@lisp
21281(add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
21282@end lisp
21283
21284
21285If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
21286the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
21287mine:
21288
21289@example
21290<x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
21291<x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
21292@end example
21293
21294So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
21295exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
21296myself:
21297
21298@lisp
21299("references"
21300 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
21301 1000 nil r))
21302@end lisp
21303
21304Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
21305is system-dependent.
21306
21307
21308@node Scoring On Other Headers
21309@section Scoring On Other Headers
21310@cindex scoring on other headers
21311
21312Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
21313headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
21314other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
21315that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
21316matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
21317
21318Now, there's not much you can do about this for news groups, but for
21319mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
21320it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
21321a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
21322@samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
21323
21324Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
21325
21326@lisp
21327(setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
21328 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
21329@end lisp
21330
21331Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
21332@kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
21333time if you have much mail.
21334
21335Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
21336so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
21337
21338See? Simple.
21339
01c52d31
MB
21340@vindex gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring
21341You can inhibit scoring the slow scoring on headers or body by setting
21342the variable @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring}. If
21343@code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring} is regexp, slow scoring is inhibited if
21344the group matches the regexp. If it is t, slow scoring on it is
21345inhibited for all groups.
21346
4009494e
GM
21347
21348@node Scoring Tips
21349@section Scoring Tips
21350@cindex scoring tips
21351
21352@table @dfn
21353
21354@item Crossposts
21355@cindex crossposts
21356@cindex scoring crossposts
21357If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
21358the @code{Xref} header.
21359@lisp
21360("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
21361@end lisp
21362
21363@item Multiple crossposts
21364If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
21365more than, say, 3 groups:
21366@lisp
21367("xref"
21368 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
21369 -1000 nil r))
21370@end lisp
21371
21372@item Matching on the body
21373This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
21374Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
21375you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
21376keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
21377and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
21378will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
21379@code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
21380the matches.
21381
21382@item Marking as read
21383You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
21384number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
21385in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
21386@lisp
21387((mark -100))
21388@end lisp
21389You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
21390
21391@item Negated character classes
21392If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
21393That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
21394@code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
21395@end table
21396
21397
21398@node Reverse Scoring
21399@section Reverse Scoring
21400@cindex reverse scoring
21401
21402If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
21403subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
21404like this in your score file:
21405
21406@lisp
21407(("subject"
21408 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
21409 (mark 1)
21410 (expunge 1))
21411@end lisp
21412
21413So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
21414rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
21415
21416
21417@node Global Score Files
21418@section Global Score Files
21419@cindex global score files
21420
21421Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
21422nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
21423in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
21424
21425What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
21426all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
21427big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
21428
21429@vindex gnus-global-score-files
21430All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
21431@code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
21432or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
21433files are applicable to which group.
21434
21435To use the score file
21436@file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
21437all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
21438say this:
21439
21440@lisp
21441(setq gnus-global-score-files
21442 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
21443 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
21444@end lisp
21445
21446@findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
21447@noindent
21448Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
21449directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
21450If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
21451use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
21452
21453Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
21454somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
21455
21456If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
21457just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
21458world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
21459wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
21460sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
21461premises! Yay! The net is saved!
21462
21463Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
21464head:
21465
21466@itemize @bullet
21467
21468@item
21469Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
21470@item
21471To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
21472@item
21473Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
21474@item
21475Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
21476lowered out of existence.
21477@item
21478Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
21479articles completely.
21480
21481@item
21482Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
21483should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
21484old articles for a long time.
21485@end itemize
21486
21487@dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
21488in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
21489Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
21490holding our breath yet?
21491
21492
21493@node Kill Files
21494@section Kill Files
21495@cindex kill files
21496
21497Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
21498entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
21499Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
21500
21501In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
21502than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
21503files into score files.
21504
21505Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
21506forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
21507sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
21508that isn't a very good idea.
21509
21510Normal kill files look like this:
21511
21512@lisp
21513(gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
21514(gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
21515(gnus-expunge "X")
21516@end lisp
21517
21518This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
21519marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
21520
21521Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
21522encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
21523interpreting it.
21524
21525Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
21526
21527@table @kbd
21528
21529@item M-k
21530@kindex M-k (Summary)
21531@findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
21532Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
21533
21534@item M-K
21535@kindex M-K (Summary)
21536@findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
21537Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
21538@end table
21539
21540Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
21541
21542@table @kbd
21543
21544@item M-k
21545@kindex M-k (Group)
21546@findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
21547Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
21548
21549@item M-K
21550@kindex M-K (Group)
21551@findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
21552Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
21553@end table
21554
21555Kill file variables:
21556
21557@table @code
21558@item gnus-kill-file-name
21559@vindex gnus-kill-file-name
21560A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
21561@file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
21562this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
21563The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
21564course) is just called @file{KILL}.
21565
21566@vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
21567@item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
21568If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
21569kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
21570kills.
21571
21572@item gnus-apply-kill-hook
21573@vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
21574@findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
21575@findex gnus-apply-kill-file
21576A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
21577@code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
21578kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
21579hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
21580kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
21581
21582@item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
21583@vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
21584A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
21585
21586@end table
21587
21588
21589@node Converting Kill Files
21590@section Converting Kill Files
21591@cindex kill files
21592@cindex converting kill files
21593
21594If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
21595score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
21596the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
21597by hand.
21598
21599The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
21600You can fetch it from
21601@uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
21602
21603If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
21604non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
21605hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
21606before.
21607
21608
4009494e
GM
21609@node Advanced Scoring
21610@section Advanced Scoring
21611
21612Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
21613really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
21614about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
21615read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
21616want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
21617
21618By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
21619scoring patterns.
21620
21621@menu
21622* Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
21623* Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
21624* Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
21625@end menu
21626
21627
21628@node Advanced Scoring Syntax
21629@subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
21630
21631Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
21632Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
21633element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
21634non-@code{nil} value.
21635
21636These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
21637operator, and various match operators.
21638
21639Logical operators:
21640
21641@table @code
21642@item &
21643@itemx and
21644This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
21645one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
21646evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
21647@code{true}.
21648
21649@item |
21650@itemx or
21651This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
21652one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
21653then this operator will return @code{false}.
21654
21655@item !
21656@itemx not
21657